MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-1-1
PROBLEM 1-1 Statement:
It is often said, "Build a better mousetrap and the world will beat a path to your door." Consider this problem and write a goal statement and a set of at least 12 task specifications that you would apply to its solution. Then suggest 3 possible concepts to achieve the goal. Make annotated, freehand sketches of the concepts.
Solution: Goal Statement: Create a mouse-free environment. Task Specifications: 1. Cost less than $1.00 per use or application. 2. Allow disposal without human contact with mouse. 3. Be safe for other animals such as house pets. 4. Provide no threat to children or adults in normal use. 5. Be a humane method for the mouse. 6. Be environmentally friendly. 7. Have a shelf-life of at least 3 months. 8. Leave no residue. 9. Create minimum audible noise in use. 10. Create no detectable odors within 1 day of use. 11. Be biodegradable. 12. Be simple to use with minimal written instructions necessary. Concepts and sketches are left to the student. There are an infinity of possibilities.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0101.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-2-1
PROBLEM 1-2 Statement:
A bowling machine is desired to allow quadriplegic youths, who can only move a joystick, to engage in the sport of bowling at a conventional bowling alley. Consider the factors involved, write a goal statement, and develop a set of at least 12 task specifications that constrain this problem. Then suggest 3 possible concepts to achieve the goal. Make annotated, freehand sketches of the concepts.
Solution: Goal Statement: Create a means to allow a quadriplegic to bowl. Task Specifications: 1. Cost no more than $2 000. 2. Portable by no more than two able-bodied adults. 3. Fit through a standard doorway. 4. Provide no threat of injury to user in normal use. 5. Operate from a 110 V, 60 Hz, 20 amp circuit. 6. Be visually unthreatening. 7. Be easily positioned at bowling alley. 8. Have ball-aiming ability, controllable by user. 9. Automatically reload returned balls. 10. Require no more than 1 able-bodied adult for assistance in use. 11. Ball release requires no more than a mouth stick-switch closure. 12. Be simple to use with minimal written instructions necessary. Concepts and sketches are left to the student. There are an infinity of possibilities.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0102.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-3-1
PROBLEM 1-3 Statement:
A quadriplegic needs an automated page turner to allow her to read books without assistance. Consider the factors involved, write a goal statement, and develop a set of at least 12 task specifications that constrain this problem. Then suggest 3 possible concepts to achieve the goal. Make annotated, freehand sketches of the concepts.
Solution: Goal Statement: Create a means to allow a quadriplegic to read standard books with minimum assistance. Task Specifications: 1. Cost no more than $1 000. 2. Useable in bed or from a seated position 3. Accept standard books from 8.5 x 11 in to 4 x 6 in in planform and up to 1.5 in thick. 4. Book may be placed, and device set up, by able-bodied person. 5. Operate from a 110 V, 60 Hz, 15 amp circuit or by battery power. 6. Be visually unthreatening and safe to use. 7. Require no more than 1 able-bodied adult for assistance in use. 8. Useable in absence of assistant once set up. 9. Not damage books. 10. Timing controlled by user. 11. Page turning requires no more than a mouth stick-switch closure. 12. Be simple to use with minimal written instructions necessary. Concepts and sketches are left to the student. There are an infinity of possibilities.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0103.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-4-1
PROBLEM 1-4 Statement: Units:
Convert a mass of 1 000 lbm to (a) lbf, (b) slugs, (c) blobs, (d) kg. blob :=
lbf sec
2
in Given:
Mass
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0104.
M := 1000 lb
1. To determine the weight of the given mass, multiply the mass value by the acceleration due to gravity, g. W := M g
W = 1000 lbf
2. Convert mass units by assigning different units to the units place-holder when displaying the mass value. Slugs
M = 31.081 slug
Blobs
M = 2.59 blob
Kilograms
M = 453.592 kg
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0104.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-5-1
PROBLEM 1-5 Statement:
A 250-lbm mass is accelerated at 40 in/sec2. Find the force in lb needed for this acceleration.
Given:
Mass
M := 250 lb
Acceleration
in a := 40 sec
Solution: 1.
2
See Mathcad file P0105.
To determine the force required, multiply the mass value, in slugs, by the acceleration in feet per second squared. Convert mass to slugs:
M = 7.770 slug
Convert acceleration to feet per second squared: F := M a
a = 3.333s
-2
ft
F = 25.9 lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0105.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-6-1
PROBLEM 1-6 Statement:
Express a 100-kg mass in units of slugs, blobs, and lbm. How much does this mass weigh?
Units:
blob
Given:
M 100 kg
lbf sec
2
in
Assumptions: The mass is at sea-level and the gravitational acceleration is g 32.174
ft sec
Solution: 1.
or 2
g 386.089
in sec
or 2
g 9.807
m sec
2
See Mathcad file P0106.
Convert mass units by assigning different units to the units place-holder when displaying the mass value. The mass, in slugs, is
M 6.85 slug
The mass, in blobs, is
M 0.571 blob
The mass, in lbm, is
M 220.5 lb
Note: Mathcad uses lbf for pound-force, and lb for pound-mass. 2.
To determine the weight of the given mass, multiply the mass value by the acceleration due to gravity, g. The weight, in lbf, is
W M g
W 220.5 lbf
The weight, in N, is
W M g
W 980.7 N
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-7-1
PROBLEM 1-7 Statement:
Prepare an interactive computer program (using, for example, Excell, Mathcad, or TKSolver) from which the cross-sectional properties for the shapes shown in the inside front cover can be calculated. Arrange the program to deal with both ips and SI unit systems and convert the results between those systems.
Solution:
See the inside front cover and Mathcad file P0107.
1.
Rectangle, let: b 3 in
h 4 in
Area
A b h
2
A 12.000 in
2
A 7742 mm Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Ix
Iy
b h
3
12 h b
4
Ix 16.000 in
6
4
6
4
Ix 6.660 10 mm 3
4
Iy 9.000 in
12
Iy 3.746 10 mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Polar moment of inertia
kx
ky
Ix
kx 1.155 in
A
kx 29.329 mm
Iy
ky 0.866 in
A
ky 21.997 mm
Jz Ix Iy
4
Jz 25.000 in
7
4
6
4
6
4
Jz 1.041 10 mm 2.
Solid circle, let: D 3 in 2
Area
A
π D 4
Ix
π D 64
Iy
π D 64
4
Ix 3.976 in
Ix 1.655 10 mm 4
Moment about y-axis
2
A 4560 mm 4
Moment about x-axis
2
A 7.069 in
4
Iy 3.976 in
Iy 1.655 10 mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
kx
Ix A
kx 0.750 in kx 19.05 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0107.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
Radius of gyration about y-axis
1-7-2
Iy
ky
ky 0.750 in ky 19.05 mm
A 4
Jz
Polar moment of inertia
3.
π D
4
Jz 7.952 in
32
6
4
6
4
6
4
6
4
5
4
5
4
Jz 3.310 10 mm
Hollow circle, let: D 3 in
d 1 in A
Area
Moment about x-axis
Ix
4
2
4
π
D d
π 64
2
2
A 6.283 in
2
A 4054 mm
D d
4
4
Ix 3.927 in
Ix 1.635 10 mm Moment about y-axis
Iy
64 π
4
D d
4
4
Iy 3.927 in
Iy 1.635 10 mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Polar moment of inertia
4.
kx
ky
Jz
Ix
kx 0.791 in
A
kx 20.08 mm
Iy
ky 0.791 in
A
ky 20.08 mm
32 π
4
D d
4
4
Jz 7.854 in
Jz 3.269 10 mm
Solid semicircle, let: D 3 in
R 0.5 D
R 1.5 in
2
Area
A
π D
2
A 3.534 in
8
2
A 2280 mm Moment about x-axis
Ix 0.1098 R
4
4
Ix 0.556 in
Ix 2.314 10 mm Moment about y-axis
Iy
π R 8
4
4
Iy 1.988 in
Iy 8.275 10 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0107.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Polar moment of inertia
1-7-3
kx
ky
Ix A Iy A
Jz Ix Iy
kx 0.397 in kx 10.073 mm ky 0.750 in ky 19.05 mm 4
Jz 2.544 in
6
4
4
4
4
4
Jz 1.059 10 mm Distances to centroid
5.
a 0.4244 R
a 0.637 in a 16.17 mm
b 0.5756 R
b 0.863 in b 21.93 mm
Right triangle, let: b 2 in Area
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
h 1 in A
Ix
Iy
b h 2
b h
A 645 mm 3
2
4
Ix 0.056 in
36 h b
2
A 1.000 in
Ix 2.312 10 mm 3
36
4
Iy 0.222 in
Iy 9.250 10 mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Polar moment of inertia
kx
ky
Ix A
Iy A
Jz Ix Iy
kx 0.236 in kx 5.987 mm ky 0.471 in ky 11.974 mm 4
Jz 0.278 in
5
Jz 1.156 10 mm
4
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0107.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-8-1
PROBLEM 1-8 Statement:
Prepare an interactive computer program (using, for example, Excell, Mathcad, or TKSolver) from which the mass properties for the solids shown in the page opposite the inside front cover can be calculated. Arrange the program to deal with both ips and SI unit systems and convert the results between those systems.
Units:
blob
Solution:
See the page opposite the inside front cover and Mathcad file P0108.
1.
lbf sec
2
in
a 2 in
Rectangular prism, let:
b 3 in
c 4 in
3
V a b c
Volume
3
γ 0.28 lbf in V 24.000 in
V 393290 mm M
Mass
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Ix
Iy
V γ
3
M 0.017 blob
g
M 3.048 kg
2
M a b
2
2
Ix 0.019 blob in
12
2
M a c
Ix 2130.4 kg mm
2
2
Iy 0.029 blob in
12
Iy 3277.6 kg mm
Moment about z-axis
Iz
2
M b c
2
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Radius of gyration about z-axis
2.Cylinder, let:
r 2 in Volume
kx
ky
kz
2
Ix
2
kx 1.041 in
M
kx 26.437 mm
Iy
ky 1.291 in
M
ky 32.791 mm
Iz
kz 1.443 in
M
kz 36.662 mm 3
L 3 in
γ 0.30 lbf in 2
V π r L
3
V 37.699 in
V 617778 mm Mass
2
Iz 0.036 blob in
12
Iz 4097.0 kg mm
Radius of gyration about x-axis
2
M
V γ g
3
M 0.029 blob M 5.13 kg
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-8-2 2
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis
Ix
Iy
Iz
M r
2
Ix 0.059 blob in
2
2
Ix 6619.4 kg mm
2
M 3 r L
2
Iy 0.051 blob in
12
2
Iy 5791.9 kg mm
2
M 3 r L
2
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Radius of gyration about z-axis
3.
Ix
kx
kx 35.921 mm
Iy
ky 1.323 in
M
ky 33.601 mm
Iz
kz
2
kx 1.414 in
M
ky
2
Iz 0.051 blob in
12
Iz 5791.9 kg mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
2
kz 1.323 in
M
kz 33.601 mm
Hollow cylinder, let: a 2 in
b 3 in
Volume
3
L 4 in
γ 0.28 lbf in
2
2
3
V π b a L
V 62.832 in
V 1029630 mm Mass
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis
Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
M
Ix
Iy
Iz
kx
ky
V γ
M 0.046 blob
g
M 7.98 kg
2
M
a b
2
3
2
2
Ix 0.296 blob in 4
Ix 3.3 10 kg mm
M 12 M 12
2
2
2
3 a 3 b L
2
Iy 0.209 blob in 4
Iy 2.4 10 kg mm
2
2
Ix M Iy M
2
3 a 3 b L
2
2
2
Iz 0.209 blob in 4
Iz 2.4 10 kg mm
2
kx 2.550 in kx 64.758 mm ky 2.141 in ky 54.378 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Radius of gyration about z-axis
4.
1-8-3 Iz
kz
kz 2.141 in
M
kz 54.378 mm
Right circular cone, let: r 2 in
3
h 5 in
γ 0.28 lbf in 2
Volume
V
π r h
3
V 20.944 in
3
V 343210 mm Mass
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
M
Ix
V γ
M 0.015 blob
g
3
M 2.66 kg 2
10
Iy M
3
2
M r
Ix 0.018 blob in
12r2 3h2 80
Ix 2059.4 kg mm
2
Iy 0.023 blob in
Iy 2638.5 kg mm
Moment about z-axis
Iz M
12r2 3h2 80
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Radius of gyration about z-axis
5.
Ix
kx
2
kx 27.824 mm
Iy
ky 1.240 in
M
ky 31.495 mm
Iz
kz
2
kx 1.095 in
M
ky
2
Iz 0.023 blob in
Iz 2638.5 kg mm Radius of gyration about x-axis
2
kz 1.240 in
M
kz 31.495 mm
Sphere, let: r 3 in Volume
Mass
Moment about x-axis
V
M
Ix
4 3
3
π r
V 1853333 mm
V γ
5
3
M 0.082 blob
g 2
3
V 113.097 in
M 14.364 kg 2
M r
2
Ix 0.295 blob in
Ix 33362 kg mm
2
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Moment about y-axis
Iy
1-8-4 2 5
2
M r
2
Iy 0.295 blob in
Iy 33362 kg mm Moment about z-axis
Radius of gyration about x-axis
Radius of gyration about y-axis
Radius of gyration about z-axis
Iz
kx
ky
kz
2 5
2
M r
2
Iz 0.295 blob in
Iz 33362 kg mm Ix M Iy M Iz M
2
2
kx 1.897 in kx 48.193 mm ky 1.897 in ky 48.193 mm kz 1.897 in kz 48.193 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-9-1
PROBLEM 1-9 Statement:
Convert the template in Problem 1-7 to have and use a set of functions or subroutines that can be called from within any program in that language to solve for the cross-sectional properties of the shapes shown on the inside front cover.
Solution:
See inside front cover and Mathcad file P0109.
1. Rectangle:
Area
A ( b h ) b h
Moment about x-axis
Ix( b h )
Moment about y-axis
Iy( b h )
3
b h 12
3
h b 12 2
2. Solid circle:
Area
A ( D)
π D 4
4
Moment about x-axis
Ix( D)
π D 64
4
Moment about y-axis
3. Hollow circle: Area
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Iy( D)
π D 64
A ( D d ) Ix( D d )
Iy( D d )
π
2
2
4
4
4
4
D d
4
π 64
π 64
D d
D d
4. Solid semicircle: 2
Area
A ( D)
π D 8
Moment about x-axis
Ix( R) 0.1098 R
Moment about y-axis
Iy( R)
π R
4
4
8
5. Right triangle: Area
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
A ( b h )
Ix( b h ) Iy( b h )
b h 2 b h
3
36 h b
3
36
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
1-10-1
PROBLEM 1-10 Statement:
Convert the template in Problem 1-8 to have and use a set of functions or subroutines that can be called from within any program in that language to solve for the cross-sectional properties of the shapes shown on the page opposite the inside front cover.
Solution:
See the page opposite the inside front cover and Mathcad file P0110.
1
Rectangular prism: Volume
V ( a b c) a b c
Mass
M ( a b c γ)
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis 2.
Ix( a b c γ) Iy( a b c γ)
Iz( a b c γ)
V ( a b c) γ g
2
2
2
2
2
2
M ( a b c γ) a b 12
M ( a b c γ) a c
12 M ( a b c γ) b c
12
Cylinder: 2
Volume
V ( r L) π r L
Mass
M ( r L γ)
V ( r L) γ g 2
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis
3.
Ix( r L γ) Iy( r L γ) Iz( r L γ)
M ( r L γ) r 2
2
2
2
12
2
M ( r L γ) 3 r L M ( r L γ) 3 r L
12
Hollow cylinder:
2
2
Volume
V ( a b L) π b a L
Mass
M ( a b L γ)
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis
Ix( a b L γ) Iy( a b L γ) Iz( a b L γ)
V ( a b L) γ g M ( a b L γ) 2 M ( a b L γ) 12 M ( a b L γ) 12
2
a b
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3 a 3 b L 3 a 3 b L
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 4. Right circular cone:
1-10-2 2
Volume
Mass
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis 5.
π r h
V ( r h )
3
M ( r h γ)
Ix( r h γ)
V ( r h ) γ g 3 10
2
M ( r h γ) r
2 2 12 r 3 h I ( r h γ) M ( r h γ) y
80
Iz( r h γ) M ( r h γ)
12r2 3h2 80
Sphere: Volume
Mass
Moment about x-axis
Moment about y-axis
Moment about z-axis
V ( r)
4 3
3
π r
M ( r γ)
V ( r) γ g
Ix( r γ)
2
Iy( r γ)
2
Iz( r γ)
2
5
5
5
2
M ( r γ) r
2
M ( r γ) r
2
M ( r γ) r
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-1-1
PROBLEM 2-1 Statement:
Figure P2-1 shows stress-strain curves for three failed tensile-test specimens. All are plotted on the same scale. (a) Characterize each material as brittle or ductile. (b) Which is the stiffest? (c) Which has the highest ultimate strength? (d) Which has the largest modulus of resilience? (e) Which has the largest modulus of toughness?
Solution:
See Figure P2-1 and Mathcad file P0201.
1.
The material in Figure P2-1(a) has a moderate amount of strain beyond the yield point, P2-1(b) has very little, and P2-1(c) has considerably more than either of the other two. Based on this observation, the material in Figure P2-1(a) is mildly ductile, that in P2-1(b)is brittle, and that in P2-1(c) is ductile.
2.
The stiffest material is the one with the grearesr slope in the elastic range. Determine this by dividing the rise by the run of the straight-line portion of each curve. The material in Figure P2-1(c) has a slope of 5 stress units per strain unit, which is the greatest of the three. Therefore, P2-1(c) is the stiffest.
3.
Ultimate strength corresponds to the highest stress that is achieved by a material under test. The material in Figure P2-1(b) has a maximum stress of 10 units, which is considerably more than either of the other two. Therefore, P2-1(b) has the highest ultimate strength.
4.
The modulus of resilience is the area under the elastic portion of the stress-starin curve. From observation of the three graphs, the stress and strain values at the yield points are: P2-1(a)
σya := 5
εya := 5
P2-1(b)
σyb := 9
εyb := 2
P2-1(c)
σyc := 5
εyc := 1
Using equation (2.7), the modulus of resiliency for each material is, approximately, P21a :=
P21b :=
P21c :=
1 2 1 2 1 2
⋅ σya ⋅ ε ya
P21a = 12.5
⋅ σyb ⋅ ε yb
P21b = 9
⋅ σyc⋅ ε yc
P21c = 2.5
P2-1 (a) has the largest modulus of resilience 5.
The modulus of toughness is the area under the stress-starin curve up to the point of fracture. By inspection, P2-1 (c) has the largest area under the stress-strain curve therefore, it has the largest modulus of toughness.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0201.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-2-1
PROBLEM 2-2 Statement:
Determine an approximate ratio between the yield strength and ultimate strength for each material shown in Figure P2-1.
Solution:
See Figure P2-1 and Mathcad file P0202.
1.
2.
The yield strength is the value of stress at which the stress-strain curve begins to be nonlinear. The ultimate strength is the maximum value of stress attained during the test. From the figure, we have the following values of yield strength and tensile strength: Figure P2-1(a)
S ya := 5
S ua := 6
Figure P2-1(b)
S yb := 9
S ub := 10
Figure P2-1(c)
S yc := 5
S uc := 8
The ratio of yield strength to ultimate strength for each material is: Figure P2-1(a)
Figure P2-1(b)
Figure P2-1(c)
ratioa :=
ratiob :=
ratioc :=
S ya S ua S yb S ub S yc S uc
ratioa = 0.83
ratiob = 0.90
ratioc = 0.63
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0202.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-3-1
PROBLEM 2-3 Statement:
Which of the steel alloys shown in Figure 2-19 would you choose to obtain (a) Maximum strength (b) Maximum modulus of resilience (c) Maximum modulus of toughness (d) Maximum stiffness
Given:
Young's modulus for steel
Solution:
See Figure 2-19 and Mathcad file P0203.
1.
E 207 GPa
Determine from the graph: values for yield strength, ultimate strength and strain at fracture for each material. Steel
Yield Strength
Ultimate Strength
Fracture Strain
AISI 1020:
Sy1020 300 MPa
Sut 1020 400 MPa
εf 1020 0.365
AISI 1095:
Sy1095 550 MPa
Sut 1095 1050 MPa
εf 1095 0.11
AISI 4142:
Sy4142 1600 MPa
Sut 4142 2430 MPa
εf 4142 0.06
Note: The 0.2% offset method was used to define a yield strength for the AISI 1095 and the 4142 steels. 2.
From the values of Sut above it is clear that the AISI 4142 has maximum strength.
3.
Using equation (2-7) and the data above, determine the modulus of resilience. 2
UR1020
1 Sy1020 2 E
UR1020 0.22
3
m 2
1 Sy1095 UR1095 2 E
UR1095 0.73
MN m 3
m 2
UR4142
MN m
1 Sy4142 2 E
UR4142 6.18
MN m 3
m Even though the data is approximate, the AISI 4142 clearly has the largest modulus of resilience. 4.
Using equation (2-8) and the data above, determine the modulus of toughness. UT1020 UT1095 UT4142
1 2 1 2 1 2
Sy1020 Sut 1020 εf 1020
UT1020 128
MN m 3
m Sy1095 Sut 1095 εf 1095
UT1095 88
MN m 3
m Sy4142 Sut 4142 εf 4142
UT4142 121
MN m 3
m
Since the data is approximate, there is no significant difference between the 1020 and 4142 steels. Because of the wide difference in shape and character of the curves, one should also determine the area under the curves by graphical means. When this is done, the area under the curve is about 62 square units for 1020 and 66 for 4142. Thus, they seem to have about equal toughness, which is about 50% greater than that for the 1095 steel. 5.
All three materials are steel therefore, the stiffnesses are the same.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-4-1
PROBLEM 2-4 Statement:
Which of the aluminum alloys shown in Figure 2-21 would you choose to obtain (a) Maximum strength (b) Maximum modulus of resilience (c) Maximum modulus of toughness (d) Maximum stiffness
Given:
Young's modulus for aluminum
Solution:
See Figure 2-21 and Mathcad file P0204.
1.
E 71.7 GPa
Determine, from the graph, values for yield strength, ultimate strength and strain at fracture for each material. Alum
Yield Strength
Ultimate Strength
Fracture Strain
1100:
Sy1100 120 MPa
Sut 1100 130 MPa
εf 1100 0.170
2024-T351:
Sy2024 330 MPa
Sut 2024 480 MPa
εf 2024 0.195
7075-T6:
Sy7075 510 MPa
Sut 7075 560 MPa
εf 7075 0.165
Note: The 0.2% offset method was used to define a yield strength for all of the aluminums. 2.
From the values of Sut above it is clear that the 7075-T6 has maximum strength.
3.
Using equation (2-7) and the data above, determine the modulus of resilience. 2
UR1100
1 Sy1100 2 E
UR1100 0.10
1 Sy2024 2 E
3
m
2
UR2024
MN m
UR2024 0.76
MN m 3
m 2
1 Sy7075 UR7075 2 E
UR7075 1.81
MN m 3
m
Even though the data is approximate, the 7075-T6 clearly has the largest modulus of resilience. 4.
Using equation (2-8) and the data above, determine the modulus of toughness. UT1100 UT2024 UT7075
1 2 1 2 1 2
Sy1100 Sut 1100 εf 1100
UT1100 21
MN m 3
m Sy2024 Sut 2024 εf 2024
UT2024 79
MN m 3
m Sy7075 Sut 7075 εf 7075
UT7075 88
MN m 3
m Even though the data is approximate, the 7075-T6 has the largest modulus of toughness. 5.
All three materials are aluminum therefore, the stiffnesses are the same.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-5-1
PROBLEM 2-5 Statement:
Which of the thermoplastic polymers shown in Figure 2-22 would you choose to obtain (a) Maximum strength (b) Maximum modulus of resilience (c) Maximum modulus of toughness (d) Maximum stiffness
Solution:
See Figure 2-22 and Mathcad file P0205.
1.
Determine, from the graph, values for yield strength, ultimate strength, strain at fracture, and modulus of elasticity for each material. Plastic
Yield Strength
Ultimate Strength
Fracture Strain
Mod of Elasticity
Nylon 101:
SyNylon 63 MPa
Sut Nylon 80 MPa
εf Nylon 0.52
ENylon 1.1 GPa
HDPE:
SyHDPE 15 MPa
Sut HDPE 23 MPa
εf HDPE 3.0
EHDPE 0.7 GPa
PTFE:
SyPTFE 8.3 MPa
Sut PTFE 13 MPa
εf PTFE 0.51
EPTFE 0.8 GPa
2.
From the values of Sut above it is clear that the Nylon 101 has maximum strength.
3.
Using equation (2-7) and the data above, determine the modulus of resilience. 2
URNylon
1 SyNylon 2 ENylon
URNylon 1.8
MN m 3
m 2
URHDPE
1 SyHDPE 2 EHDPE 1 SyPTFE 2 EPTFE
3
m
2
URPTFE
MN m
URHDPE 0.16
URPTFE 0.04
MN m 3
m
Even though the data is approximate, the Nylon 101 clearly has the largest modulus of resilience. 4.
Using equation (2-8) and the data above, determine the modulus of toughness. UTNylon
UTHDPE
UTPTFE
SyNylon Sut Nylon εf Nylon
1 2
2
2
MN m 3
m
1
1
UTNylon 37
SyHDPE SutHDPE εf HDPE
SyPTFE SutPTFE εf PTFE
UTHDPE 57
MN m 3
m UTPTFE 5
MN m 3
m
Even though the data is approximate, the HDPE has the largest modulus of toughness. 5.
The Nylon 101 has the steepest slope in the (approximately) elastic range and is, therefore, the stiffest of the three materials..
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-6-1
PROBLEM 2-6 Statement:
A metal has a strength of 414 MPa at its elastic limit and the strain at that point is 0.002. What is the modulus of elasticity? What is the strain energy at the elastic limit? Assume that the test speimen is 12.8-mm dia and has a 50-mm gage length. Can you define the type of metal based on the given data?
Given:
Elastic limit: Strength
S el 414 MPa
Strain
Test specimen: Diameter d o 12.8 mm Solution: 1.
Length Lo 50 mm
See Mathcad file P0206.
The modulus of elasticity is the slope of the stress-strain curve, which is a straight line, in the elastic region. Since one end of this line is at the origin, the slope (modulus of elasticity) is E
2.
ε el 0.002
S el
E 207 GPa
ε el
The strain energy per unit volume at the elastic limit is the area under the stress-strain curve up to the elastic limit. Since the curve is a straight line up to this limit, the area is one-half the base times the height, or U'el
1 2
S el ε el
U'el 414
kN m 3
m
The total strain energy in the specimen is the strain energy per unit volume times the volume,
Uel U'el
3.
π d o 4
2
Lo
Uel 2.7 N m
Based on the modulus of elasticity and using Table C-1, the material is steel.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-7-1
PROBLEM 2-7 Statement:
A metal has a strength of 41.2 kpsi (284 MPa) at its elastic limit and the strain at that point is 0.004. What is the modulus of elasticity? What is the strain energy at the elastic limit? Assume that the test speimen is 0.505-in dia and has a 2-in gage length. Can you define the type of metal based on the given data?
Given:
Elastic limit: Strength
S el 41.2 ksi
Strain
Test specimen: Diameter d o 0.505 in Solution: 1.
S el 284 MPa
Length Lo 2.00 in
See Mathcad file P0207.
The modulus of elasticity is the slope of the stress-strain curve, which is a straight line, in the elastic region. Since one end of this line is at the origin, the slope (modulus of elasticity) is E
2.
ε el 0.004
S el
6
E 10.3 10 psi
ε el
E 71 GPa
The strain energy per unit volume at the elastic limit is the area under the stress-strain curve up to the elastic limit. Since the curve is a straight line up to this limit, the area is one-half the base times the height, or
U'el
1 2
S el ε el
U'el 82.4
lbf in 3
U'el 568
in
kN m 3
m
The total strain energy in the specimen is the strain energy per unit volume times the volume, Uel U'el 3.
π d o 4
2
Lo
Uel 33.0 in lbf
Based on the modulus of elasticity and using Table C-1, the material is aluminum.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-8-1
PROBLEM 2-8 Statement:
A metal has a strength of 134 MPa at its elastic limit and the strain at that point is 0.006. What is the modulus of elasticity? What is the strain energy at the elastic limit? Assume that the test speimen is 12.8-mm dia and has a 50-mm gage length. Can you define the type of metal based on the given data?
Given:
Elastic limit: Strength
S el 134 MPa
Strain
Test specimen: Diameter d o 12.8 mm Solution: 1.
Length Lo 50 mm
See Mathcad file P0208.
The modulus of elasticity is the slope of the stress-strain curve, which is a straight line, in the elastic region. Since one end of this line is at the origin, the slope (modulus of elasticity) is E
2.
ε el 0.003
S el
E 45 GPa
ε el
The strain energy per unit volume at the elastic limit is the area under the stress-strain curve up to the elastic limit. Since the curve is a straight line up to this limit, the area is one-half the base times the height, or U'el
1 2
S el ε el
U'el 201
kN m 3
m
The total strain energy in the specimen is the strain energy per unit volume times the volume,
Uel U'el
3.
π d o 4
2
Lo
Uel 1.3 N m
Based on the modulus of elasticity and using Table C-1, the material is magnesium.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-9-1
PROBLEM 2-9 Statement:
A metal has a strength of 100 kpsi (689 MPa) at its elastic limit and the strain at that point is 0.006. What is the modulus of elasticity? What is the strain energy at the elastic limit? Assume that the test speimen is 0.505-in dia and has a 2-in gage length. Can you define the type of metal based on the given data?
Given:
Elastic limit: Strength
S el 100 ksi
Strain
ε el 0.006
S el 689 MPa Test specimen: Diameter d o 0.505 in Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0209.
The modulus of elasticity is the slope of the stress-strain curve, which is a straight line, in the elastic region. Since one end of this line is at the origin, the slope (modulus of elasticity) is E
2.
Length Lo 2.00 in
S el
6
E 16.7 10 psi
ε el
E 115 GPa
The strain energy per unit volume at the elastic limit is the area under the stress-strain curve up to the elastic limit. Since the curve is a straight line up to this limit, the area is one-half the base times the height, or U'el
1 2
S el ε el
U'el 300
lbf in 3
3 kN m
U'el 2 10
in
3
m
The total strain energy in the specimen is the strain energy per unit volume times the volume,
Uel U'el
3.
π d o 4
2
Lo
Uel 120.18 in lbf
Based on the modulus of elasticity and using Table C-1, the material is titanium.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-10-1
PROBLEM 2-10 Statement:
A material has a yield strength of 689 MPa at an offset of 0.6% strain. What is its modulus of resilience?
Units:
MJ 10 joule
Given:
Yield strength
S y 689 MPa
Yield strain
ε y 0.006
Solution: 1.
6
See Mathcad file P0210.
The modulus of resilience (strain energy per unit volume) is given by Equation (2.7) and is approximately
UR
1 2
S y ε y
UR 2.067
MJ 3
UR 2.1 MPa
m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-11-1
PROBLEM 2-11 Statement:
A material has a yield strength of 60 ksi (414 MPa) at an offset of 0.2% strain. What is its modulus of resilience?
Units:
MJ 10 joule
Given:
Yield strength
S y 60 ksi
Yield strain
ε y 0.002
Solution: 1.
6
S y 414 MPa
See Mathcad file P0211.
The modulus of resilience (strain energy per unit volume) is given by Equation (2.7) and is approximately
UR
1 2
S y ε y
UR 60
in lbf 3
in
UR 0.414
MJ 3
UR 0.414 MPa
m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-12-1
PROBLEM 2-12 Statement:
A steel has a yield strength of 414 MPa, an ultimate tensile strength of 689 MPa, and an elongation at fracture of 15%. What is its approximate modulus of toughness? What is the approximate modulus of resilience?
Given:
S y 414 MPa
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0212.
1.
ε f 0.15
Determine the modulus of toughness using Equation (2.8).
UT
2.
S ut 689 MPa
Sy S ut εf 2
UT 82.7
MN m 3
UT 82.7 MPa
m
Determine the modulus of resilience using Equation (2.7) and Young's modulus for steel: E 207 GPa 2
1 Sy UR 2 E
UR 414
kN m 3
UR 0.41 MPa
m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-13-1
PROBLEM 2-13 Statement:
The Brinell hardness of a steel specimen was measured to be 250 HB. What is the material's approximate tensile strength? What is the hardness on the Vickers scale? The Rockwell scale?
Given:
Brinell hardness of specimen
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0213.
HB 250
1. Determine the approximate tensile strength of the material from equations (2.10), not Table 2-3. S ut 0.5 HB ksi
S ut 125 ksi
S ut 862 MPa
2. From Table 2-3 (using linear interpolation) the hardness on the Vickers scale is HV
HB 241 277 241
( 292 253 ) 253
HV 263
3. From Table 2-3 (using linear interpolation) the hardness on the Rockwell C scale is HRC
HB 241 277 241
( 28.8 22.8) 22.8
HRC 24.3
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-14-1
PROBLEM 2-14 Statement:
The Brinell hardness of a steel specimen was measured to be 340 HB. What is the material's approximate tensile strength? What is the hardness on the Vickers scale? The Rockwell scale?
Given:
Brinell hardness of specimen
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0214.
HB 340
1. Determine the approximate tensile strength of the material from equations (2.10), not Table 2-3. S ut 0.5 HB ksi
S ut 170 ksi
S ut 1172 MPa
2. From Table 2-3 (using linear interpolation) the hardness on the Vickers scale is HV
HB 311 341 311
( 360 328 ) 328
HV 359
3. From Table 2-3 (using linear interpolation) the hardness on the Rockwell C scale is HRC
HB 311 341 311
( 36.6 33.1) 33.1
HRC 36.5
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-15-1
PROBLEM 2-15 Statement:
What are the principal alloy elements of an AISI 4340 steel? How much carbon does it have? Is it hardenable? By what techniques?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0215.
1. Determine the principal alloying elements from Table 2-5 for 43xx steel.. 1.82% Nickel 0.50 or 0.80% Chromium 0.25% Molybdenum 2. From "Steel Numbering Systems" in Section 2.6, the carbon content is From the last two digits, the carbon content is 0.40%. 3. Is it hardenable? Yes, all of the alloying elements increase the hardenability. By what techniques? It can be through hardened by heating, quenching and tempering; and it can also be case hardened (See Section 2.4).
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0215.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-16-1
PROBLEM 2-16 Statement:
What are the principal alloy elements of an AISI 1095 steel? How much carbon does it have? Is it hardenable? By what techniques?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0216.
1. Determine the principal alloying elements from Table 2-5 for 10xx steel. Carbon only, no alloying elements 2. From "Steel Numbering Systems" in Section 2.6, the carbon content is From the last two digits, the carbon content is 0.95%. 3. Is it hardenable? Yes, as a high-carbon steel, it has sufficient carbon content for hardening. By what techniques? It can be through hardened by heating, quenching and tempering; and it can also be case hardened (See Section 2.4).
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0216.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-17-1
PROBLEM 2-17 Statement:
What are the principal alloy elements of an AISI 6180 steel? How much carbon does it have? Is it hardenable? By what techniques?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0217.
1. Determine the principal alloying elements from Table 2-5 for 61xx steel.. 0.15% Vanadium 0.60 to 0.95% Chromium 2. From "Steel Numbering Systems" in Section 2.6, the carbon content is From the last two digits, the carbon content is 0.80%. 3. Is it hardenable? Yes, all of the alloying elements increase the hardenability. By what techniques? It can be through hardened by heating, quenching and tempering; and it can also be case hardened (See Section 2.4).
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0217.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-18-1
PROBLEM 2-18 Statement:
Which of the steels in Problems 2-15, 2-16, and 2-17 is the stiffest?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0218.
1. None. All steel alloys have the same Young's modulus, which determines stiffness.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0218.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-19-1
PROBLEM 2-19 Statement:
Calculate the specific strength and specific stiffness of the following materials and pick one for use in an aircraft wing spar.
Given:
Material
Code
Steel
st 0
Ultimate Strength Sut 80 ksi st
Young's Modulus 6
E 30 10 psi st
Weight Density lbf
γ 0.28 st
3
in Aluminum
al 1
Sut
al
60 ksi
E
6
al
10.4 10 psi
γ 0.10
lbf
al
3
in Titanium
ti 2
Sut 90 ksi ti
6
E 16.5 10 psi ti
γ 0.16 ti
lbf 3
in Index Solution: 1.
i 0 1 2
See Mathcad file P0219.
Specific strength is the ultimate tensile strength divided by the weight density and specific stiffness is the modulus of elasticity divided by the weight density. The text does not give a symbol to these quantities. Sut Specific strength
γ
i 1
i
in
E
286·103 600·103 563·103
2.
Specific stiffness
i 1
γ in
i
Steel Aluminum Titanium
107·106 104·106 103·106
Based on the results above, all three materials have the same specific stiffness but the aluminum has the largest specific strength. Aluminum for the aircraft wing spar is recommended.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-20-1
PROBLEM 2-20 Statement:
If maximum impact resistance were desired in a part, which material properties would you look for?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0220.
1. Ductility and a large modulus of toughness (see "Impact Resistance" in Section 2.1).
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0220.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-21-1
PROBLEM 2-21
_____
Statement:
Refer to the tables of material data in Appendix A and determine the strength-to-weight ratios of the following material alloys based on their tensile yield strengths: heat-treated 2024 aluminum, SAE 1040 cold-rolled steel, Ti-75A titanium, type 302 cold-rolled stainless steel.
Given:
Material
Yield Strength
Mat "2024 Aluminum, HT" Sy 290 MPa 1
1
Specific Weight 3
γ 0.10 lbf in
γ 27.14
1
1
kN 3
m Mat "1040 CR Steel" 2
Sy 490 MPa 2
3
γ 0.28 lbf in
γ 76.01
2
2
kN 3
m Mat "Ti-75A Titanium" 3
Sy 517 MPa 3
3
γ 0.16 lbf in
γ 43.43
3
3
kN 3
m Mat "Type 302 CR SS" 4
Sy 1138 MPa 4
3
γ 0.28 lbf in
γ 76.01
4
4
kN 3
m i 1 2 4 Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0221.
Calculate the strength-to-weight ratio for each material as described in Section 2.1.
SWR i
Sy
SWR
γ
10 m
i
i
4
i
"2024 Aluminum, HT" "1040 CR Steel" Mat i "Ti-75A Titanium" "Type 302 CR SS"
1.068 0.645 1.190 1.497
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-22-1
PROBLEM 2-22
_____
Statement:
Refer to the tables of material data in Appendix A and determine the strength-to-weight ratios of the following material alloys based on their ultimate tensile strengths: heat-treated 2024 aluminum SAE 1040 cold-rolled steel, unfilled acetal plastic, Ti-75A titanium, type 302 cold-rolled stainless steel.
Given:
Material
Tensile Strength
Specific Weight 3
Mat "2024 Aluminum, HT" Sut 441 MPa
γ 0.10 lbf in
Mat "1040 CR Steel"
Sut 586 MPa
γ 0.28 lbf in
Mat "Acetal, unfilled"
Sut 60.7 MPa
γ 0.051 lbf in
Mat "Ti-75A Titanium"
Sut 586 MPa
γ 0.16 lbf in
Mat "Type 302 CR SS"
Sut 1310 MPa
γ 0.28 lbf in
1
1
2 3 4 5
2 3 4 5
3
γ 27.14 kN m
1
1
3
3
γ 76.01 kN m
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
γ 43.43 kN m
4
4
3
5
3
γ 13.84 kN m
3
γ 76.01 kN m 5
i 1 2 5 Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0222.
Calculate the strength-to-weight ratio for each material as described in Section 2.1.
Sut SWR i
γ
SWR
i
i
4
10 m
i
"2024 Aluminum, HT"
"1040 CR Steel" Mat "Acetal, unfilled" i "Ti-75A Titanium" "Type 302 CR SS"
1.625 0.771 0.438 1.349 1.724
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
PROBLEM 2-23
2-23-1
_____
Statement:
Refer to the tables of material data in Appendix A and calculate the specific stiffness of aluminum, titanium, gray cast iron, ductile iron, bronze, carbon steel, and stainless steel. Rank them in increasing order of this property and discuss the engineering significance of these data.
Units:
Mg 10 kg
Given:
Material
3
Modulus of Elasticity
Density 3
Mat "Aluminum"
E 71.7 GPa
ρ 2.8 Mg m
Mat "Titanium"
E 113.8 GPa
ρ 4.4 Mg m
Mat "Gray cast iron"
E 103.4 GPa
ρ 7.2 Mg m
Mat "Ductile iron"
E 168.9 GPa
ρ 6.9 Mg m
Mat "Bronze"
E 110.3 GPa
ρ 8.6 Mg m
Mat "Carbon steel"
E 206.8 GPa
ρ 7.8 Mg m
Mat "Stainless steel"
E 189.6 GPa
ρ 7.8 Mg m
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
1
3
2
3
3
3
4
3
5
3
6
3
7
i 1 2 7 Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0223.
Calculate the specific stiffness for each material as described in Section 2.1. E E' i
2.
ρ
E'
i i
"Aluminum" "Titanium" "Gray cast iron" Mat "Ductile iron" i "Bronze" "Carbon steel" "Stainless steel"
10
i 6
2
s
2
m
25.6 25.9 14.4 24.5 12.8 26.5 24.3
Rank them in increasing order of specific stiffness. E' Mat "Bronze"
2 5 s
5
10 E' Mat "Gray cast iron"
10 E'
2
6
2
10
6
14.4
m
2 7 s
7
12.8
m
2 3 s
3
Mat "Stainless steel"
6
2
24.3
m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
E' Mat "Ductile iron"
2 4 s
4
10 E' Mat "Aluminum"
10 E'
10 E'
6
2
6
10
6
24.5
25.6
m
2
25.9
m
2 6 s
6
3.
2
m
2 2 s
2
Mat "Carbon steel"
2 1 s
1
Mat "Titanium"
6
2-23-2
2
26.5
m
Bending and axial deflection are inversely proportional to the modulus of elasticity. For the same shape and dimensions, the material with the highest specific stiffness will give the smallest deflection. Or, put another way, for a given deflection, using the material with the highest specific stiffness will result in the least weight.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-24-1
PROBLEM 2-24 Statement:
Call your local steel and aluminum distributors (consult the Yellow Pages) and obtain current costs per pound for round stock of consistent size in low-carbon (SAE 1020) steel, SAE 4340 steel, 2024-T4 aluminum, and 6061-T6 aluminum. Calculate a strength/dollar ratio and a stiffness/dollar ratio for each alloy. Which would be your first choice on a cost-efficiency basis for an axial-tension-loaded round rod (a) If maximum strength were needed? (b) If maximum stiffness were needed?
Solution:
Left to the student as data will vary with time and location.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-25-1
PROBLEM 2-25 Statement:
Call your local plastic stock-shapes distributors (consult the Yellow Pages) and obtain current costs per pound for round rod or tubing of consistent size in plexiglass, acetal, nylon 6/6, and PVC. Calculate a strength/dollar ratio and a stiffness/dollar ratio for each alloy. Which would be your first choice on a cost-efficiency basis for an axial-tension-loaded round rod or tube of particular diameters. (a) If maximum strength were needed? (b) If maximum stiffness were needed?
Solution:
Left to the student as data will vary with time and location.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-26-1
PROBLEM 2-26 Statement:
A part has been designed and its dimensions cannot be changed. To minimize its deflections under the same loading in all directions irrespective of stress levels, which material woulod you choose among the following: aluminum, titanium, steel, or stainless steel?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0226.
1.
Choose the material with the highest modulus of elasticity because deflection is inversely proportional to modulus of elasticity. Thus, choose steel unless there is a corrosive atmosphere, in which case, choose stainless steel.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0226.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-27-1
PROBLEM 2-27 Statement:
Assuming that the mechanical properties data given in Appendix Table A-9 for some carbon steels represents mean values, what is the value of the tensile yield strength for 1050 steel quenched and tempered at 400F if a reliability of 99.9% is required?
Given:
Mean yield strength
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0227.
1.
S y 117 ksi
S y 807 MPa
From Table 2-2 the reliability factor for 99.9% is Re 0.753. Applying this to the mean tensile strength gives S y99.9 S y Re
S y99.9 88.1 ksi
S y99.9 607 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-28-1
PROBLEM 2-28 Statement:
Assuming that the mechanical properties data given in Appendix Table A-9 for some carbon steels represents mean values, what is the value of the ultimate tensile strength for 4340 steel quenched and tempered at 800F if a reliability of 99.99% is required?
Given:
Mean ultimate tensile strength
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0228.
1.
S ut 213 ksi
S ut 1469 MPa
From Table 2-2 the reliability factor for 99.99% is Re 0.702. Applying this to the mean ultimate tensile strength gives S ut99.99 S ut Re
S ut99.99 150 ksi
S ut99.99 1031 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-29-1
PROBLEM 2-29 Statement:
Assuming that the mechanical properties data given in Appendix Table A-9 for some carbon steels represents mean values, what is the value of the ultimate tensile strength for 4130 steel quenched and tempered at 400F if a reliability of 90% is required?
Given:
Mean ultimate tensile strength
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0229.
1.
S ut 236 ksi
S ut 1627 MPa
From Table 2-2 the reliability factor for 90% is Re 0.897. Applying this to the mean ultimate tensile strength gives S ut99.99 S ut Re
S ut99.99 212 ksi
S ut99.99 1460 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-30-1
PROBLEM 2-30 Statement:
Assuming that the mechanical properties data given in Appendix Table A-9 for some carbon steels represents mean values, what is the value of the tensile yield strength for 4140 steel quenched and tempered at 800F if a reliability of 99.999% is required?
Given:
Mean yield strength
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0230.
S y 165 ksi
S y 1138 MPa
1. From Table 2-2 the reliability factor for 99.999% is Re 0.659. Applying this to the mean tensile strength gives S y99.9 S y Re S y99.9 109 ksi S y99.9 750 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-31-1
PROBLEM 2-31 Statement:
A steel part is to be plated to give it better corrosion resistance. Two materials are being considered: cadmium and nickel. Considering only the problem of galvanic action, which would you chose? Why?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0231.
1.
From Table 2-4 we see that cadmium is closer to steel than nickel. Therefore, from the standpoint of reduced galvanic action, cadmium is the better choice. Also, since cadmium is less noble than steel it will be the material that is consumed by the galvanic action. If nickel were used the steel would be consumed by galvanic action.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0231.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-32-1
PROBLEM 2-32 Statement:
A steel part with many holes and sharp corners is to be plated with nickel. Two processes are being considered: electroplating and electroless plating. Which process would you chose? Why?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0232.
1.
Electroless plating is the better choice since it will give a uniform coating thickness in the sharp corners and in the holes. It also provides a relatively hard surface of about 43 HRC.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0232.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-33-1
PROBLEM 2-33 Statement:
What is the common treatment used on aluminum to prevent oxidation? What other metals can also be treated with this method? What options are available with this method?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0233.
1.
Aluminum is commonly treated by anodizing, which creates a thin layer of aluminum oxide on the surface. Titanium, magnesium, and zinc can also be anodized. Common options include tinting to give various colors to the surface and the use of "hard anodizing" to create a thicker, harder surface.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0233.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-34-1
PROBLEM 2-34 Statement:
Steel is often plated with a less nobel metal that acts as a sacrificial anode that will corrode instead of the steel. What metal is commonly used for this purpose (when the finished product will not be exposed to saltwater), what is the coating process called, and what are the common processes used to obtain the finished product?
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0234.
1.
The most commonly used metal is zinc. The process is called "galvanizing" and it is accomplished by electroplating or hot dipping.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0234.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-35-1
PROBLEM 2-35 Statement:
A low-carbon steel part is to be heat-treated to increase its strength. If an ultimate tensile strength of approximately 550 MPa is required, what mean Brinell hardness should the part have after treatment? What is the equivalent hardness on the Rockwell scale?
Given:
Approximate tensile strength
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0235.
1.
Use equation (2.10), solving for the Brinell hardness, HB. S ut = 3.45 HB
2.
S ut 550 MPa
HB
S ut 3.45 MPa
HB 159
From Table 2-3, the equivalent hardness on the Rocwell scale is 83.9HRB.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-36-1
PROBLEM 2-36 Statement:
A low-carbon steel part has been tested for hardness using the Brinell method and is found to have a hardness of 220 HB. What are the approximate lower and upper limits of the ultimate tensile strength of this part in MPa?
Given:
Hardness
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0236.
1.
HB 220
Use equation (2.10), solving for ultimate tensile strength. Minimum:
S utmin ( 3.45 HB 0.2 HB) MPa
S utmin 715 MPa
Maximum:
S utmax ( 3.45 HB 0.2 HB) MPa
S utmax 803 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-37-1
PROBLEM 2-37 Statement:
Figure 2-24 shows "guide lines" for minimum weight design when failure is the criterion. The guide line, or index, for minimizing the weight of a beam in bending is f2/3/, where f is the yield strength of a material and is its mass density. For a given cross-section shape the weight of a beam with given loading will be minimized when this index is maximized. The following materials are being considered for a beam application: 5052 aluminum, cold rolled; CA-170 beryllium copper, hard plus aged; and 4130 steel, Q & T @ 1200F. The use of which of these three materials will result in the least-weight beam? 3
Units:
Mg kg
Given:
5052 Aluminum
3
S ya 255 MPa
ρa 2.8 Mg m
3
CA-170 beryllium copper S yb 1172 MPa 4130 steel Solution:
ρb 8.3 Mg m
3
S ys 703 MPa
ρs 7.8 Mg m
See Mathcad file P0237.
1.
The values for the mass density are taken from Appendix Table A-1 and the values of yield strength come from from Tables A-2, A-4, and A-9 for aluminum, beryllium copper, and steel, respectively.
2.
Calculate the index value for each material. Index S y ρ
3
0.667
Sy
ρ
Mg m
0.667
MPa
Aluminum
Ia Index S ya ρa
Ia 14.4
Beryllium copper
Ib Index S yb ρb
Ib 13.4
Steel
Is Index S ys ρs
Is 10.2
The 5052 aluminum has the highest value of the index and would be the best choice to minimize weight.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-38-1
PROBLEM 2-38 Statement:
Figure 2-24 shows "guide lines" for minimum weight design when failure is the criterion. The guide line, or index, for minimizing the weight of a member in tension is f/, where f is the yield strength of a material and is its mass density. The weight of a member with given loading will be minimized when this index is maximized. For the three materials given in Problem 2-37, which will result in the least weight tension member? 3
Units:
Mg kg
Given:
5052 Aluminum
3
S ya 255 MPa
ρa 2.8 Mg m
CA-170 beryllium copper S yb 1172 MPa 4130 steel Solution:
3
ρb 8.3 Mg m
3
S ys 703 MPa
ρs 7.8 Mg m
See Mathcad file P0238.
1.
The values for the mass density are taken from Appendix Table A-1 and the values of yield strength come from from Tables A-2, A-4, and A-9 for aluminum, beryllium copper, and steel, respectively.
2.
Calculate the index value for each material. Index S y ρ
S y Mg m 3 MPa ρ
Aluminum
Ia Index S ya ρa
Ia 91.1
Beryllium copper
Ib Index S yb ρb
Ib 141.2
Steel
Is Index S ys ρs
Is 90.1
The beryllium copper has the highest value of the index and would be the best choice to minimize weight.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-39-1
PROBLEM 2-39 Statement:
Figure 2-23 shows "guide lines" for minimum weight design when stiffness is the criterion. The guide line, or index, for minimizing the weight of a beam in bending is E1/2/, where E is the modulus of elasticity of a material and is its mass density. For a given cross-section shape the weight of a beam with given stiffness will be minimized when this index is maximized. The following materials are being considered for a beam application: 5052 aluminum, cold rolled; CA-170 beryllium copper, hard plus aged; and 4130 steel, Q & T @ 1200F. The use of which of these three materials will result in the least-weight beam? 3
Units:
Mg kg
Given:
5052 Aluminum
ρa 2.8 Mg m
3
CA-170 beryllium copper Eb 127.6 GPa
ρb 8.3 Mg m
Es 206.8 GPa
ρs 7.8 Mg m
4130 steel Solution:
3
Ea 71.7 GPa
3
See Mathcad file P0239.
1.
The values for the mass density and modulus are taken from Appendix Table A-1.
2.
Calculate the index value for each material.
Index( E ρ )
E
3
0.5
ρ
Mg m GPa
0.5
Aluminum
Ia Index Ea ρa
Ia 3.0
Beryllium copper
Ib Index Eb ρb
Ib 1.4
Steel
Is Index Es ρs
Is 1.8
The 5052 aluminum has the highest value of the index and would be the best choice to minimize weight.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
2-40-1
PROBLEM 2-40 Statement:
Figure 2-24 shows "guide lines" for minimum weight design when stiffness is the criterion. The guide line, or index, for minimizing the weight of a member in tension is E/, where E is the modulus of elasticity of a material and is its mass density. The weight of a member with given stiffness will be minimized when this index is maximized. For the three materials given in Problem 2-39, which will result in the least weight tension member?
Units:
Mg kg
Given:
5052 Aluminum
3
ρa 2.8 Mg m
3
CA-170 beryllium copper Eb 127.6 GPa
ρb 8.3 Mg m
Es 206.8 GPa
ρs 7.8 Mg m
4130 steel Solution:
3
Ea 71.7 GPa
3
See Mathcad file P0240.
1.
The values for the mass density and modulus are taken from Appendix Table A-1.
2.
Calculate the index value for each material. 3
Index( E ρ )
E Mg m ρ GPa
Aluminum
Ia Index Ea ρa
Ia 25.6
Beryllium copper
Ib Index Eb ρb
Ib 15.4
Steel
Is Index Es ρs
Is 26.5
The steel has the highest value of the index and would be the best choice to minimize weight.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-1-1
PROBLEM 3-1 Statement:
Which load class from Table 3-1 best suits these systems? (a) Bicycle frame (b) Flag pole (c) Boat oar (d) Diving board (e) Pipe wrench (f) Golf club.
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0301.
1. Determine whether the system has stationary or moving elements, and whether the there are constant or time-varying loads. (a) Bicycle frame Class 4 (Moving element, time-varying loads) (b) Flag pole
Class 2 (Stationary element, time-varying loads)
(c) Boat oar
Class 2 (Low acceleration element, time-varying loads)
(d) Diving board Class 2 (Stationary element, time-varying loads) (e) Pipe wrench Class 2 (Low acceleration elements, time-varying loads) (f) Golf club
Class 4 (Moving element, time-varying loads)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0301.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-2a-1
PROBLEM 3-2a Statement:
Draw free-body diagrams for the system of Problem 3-1a (bicycle frame).
Assumptions: 1. A two-dimensional model is adequate. 2. The lower front-fork bearing at C takes all of the thrust load from the front forks. 3. There are no significant forces on the handle bars. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0302a.
A typical bicycle frame is shown in Figure 3-2a. There are five points on the frame where external forces and moments are present. The rider's seat is mounted through a tube at A. This is a rigid connection, capable of transmitting two force components and a moment. The handle bars and front-wheel forks are supported by the frame through two bearings, located at B and C. These bearings are capable of transmitting radial and axial loads. The pedal-arm assembly is supported by bearings at D. These bearings are capable of transmitting radial loads. The rear wheel-sprocket assembly is supported by bearings mounted on an axle fixed to the frame at E.
Ma
Rb
Ra
A
B Fbr
Fax
Fct Fcr
Rc
α C
Fay Rd Re Fey
Fex
E
Fdx
D
Fdy
FIGURE 3-2a Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-2a
2. The loads at B and C can be determined by analyzing a FBD of the front wheel-front forks assembly. The loads at D can be determined by analyzing a FBD of the pedal-arm and front sprocket (see Problem 3-3), and the loads at E can be determined by analyzing a FBD of the rear wheel-sprocket assembly. 3. With the loads at B, C, D, and E known, we can apply equations 3.3b to the FBD of the frame and solve for Fax , Fay , and Ma.
Σ Fx :
−Fax − Fbr⋅ cos( α) + Fcr⋅ cos( α) − Fct⋅ sin( α) − Fdx + Fex = 0
(1)
Σ Fy :
−Fay − Fbr⋅ sin( α) + Fcr⋅ sin( α) + Fct⋅ cos( α) − Fdy + Fey = 0
(2)
Σ Mz:
Ma + ( Rbx ⋅ Fby − Rby⋅ Fbx ) + ( Rcx⋅ Fcy − Rcy⋅ Fcx) ... = 0 + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) ex ey ey ex dx dy dy dx
(3)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0302a.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-2e-1
PROBLEM 3-2e Statement:
Draw free-body diagrams for the system of Problem 3-1e (pipe wrench).
Assumptions: A two-dimensional model is adequate. Solution:
See Mathcad file P0302e.
1. A typical pipe wrench with a pipe clamped in its jaw is shown in Figure 3-2e(a). When a force Fhand is applied on the wrench, the piping system provides an equal and opposite force and a resisting torque, Tpipe.
Fhand
Tpipe Fhand a
(a) FBD of pipe wrench and pipe
Fbt Fbn Fax
A α Fay d
b
(b) FBD of pipe wrench only FIGURE 3-2e Free Body Diagrams for Problem 3-2e
2. The pipe reacts with the wrench at the points of contact A and B. The forces here will be directed along the common normals and tangents. The jaws are slightly tapered and, as a result, the action of Fhand tends to drive the wrench further into the taper, increasing the normal forces. This, in turn, allows for increasing tangential forces. It is the tangential forces that produce the turning torque. 3.
4.
Applying equations 3.3b to the FBD of the pipe wrench,
Σ Fx :
−Fax + Fbn⋅ cos( α) − Fbt⋅ sin( α) = 0
(1)
Σ Fy :
−Fay + Fbn⋅ sin( α) + Fbt⋅ cos( α) − Fhand = 0
(2)
Σ M A:
d ⋅ ( Fbt⋅ cos( α) + Fbn⋅ sin( α) ) − ( d + a ) ⋅ Fhand = 0
(3)
These equations can be solved for the vertical forces if we assume α is small so that sin(α) = 0 and cos (α) = 1.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0302e.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-3-1
PROBLEM 3-3 Statement:
Draw a free-body diagram of the pedal-arm assembly from a bicycle with the pedal arms in the horizontal position and dimensions as shown in Figure P3-1. (Consider the two arms, pedals and pivot as one piece). Assuming a rider-applied force of 1500 N at the pedal, determine the torque applied to the chain sprocket and the maximum bending moment and torque in the pedal arm.
Given:
a 170 mm
b 60 mm
Frider 1.5 kN
Assumptions: The pedal-arm assembly is supprted by bearings at A and at B. Solution:
See Figure 3-3 and Mathcad file P0303.
1. The free-body diagram (FBD) of the pedal-arm assembly (including the sprocket) is shown in Figure 3-3a. The rider-applied force is Frider and the force applied by the chain (not shown) is Fchain. The radial bearing reactions are Fax, Faz, Fbx, and Fbz. Thus, there are five unknowns Fchain, Fax, Faz, Fbx, and Fbz. In general, we can write six equilibrium equations for a three-dimensional force system, but in this system there are no forces in the y-direction so five equations are available to solve for the unknowns. z Fchain Sprocket
Faz Fbz
a Frider
A B
Arm
b
Arm (sectioned)
Fax Fbx
y
Pedal x
(a) FBD of complete pedal-arm assembly z
a
Tc
Frider b
Mc Arm
Fc
y
Pedal x
(b) FBD of pedal and arm with section through the origin FIGURE 3-3 Dimensions and Free Body Diagram of the pedal-arm assembly for Problem 3-3
2.
The torque available to turn the sprocket is found by summing moments about the sprocket axis. From Figure 3-3a, it is
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
Ty-axis:
3-3-2
a Frider r Fchain = a Frider Tsprocket = 0 Tsprocket a Frider
Tsprocket 255 N m
where r is the sprocket pitch radius. 3.
In order to determine the bending moment and twisting torque in the pedal arm, we will cut the arm with a section plane that goes through the origin and is parallel to the y-z plane, removing everything beyond that plane and replacing it with the internal forces and moments in the pedal arm at the section. The resulting FBD is shown in Figure 3-3b. The internal force at section C is Fc the internal bending moment is Mc, and the internal twisting moment (torque) is Tc. We can write three equilibrium equations to solve for these three unknowns: Shear force in pedal arm at section C
Fz :
Fc Frider = 0
Fc Frider
Fc 1.5 kN
Mc a Frider
Mc 255 N m
Tc b Frider
Tc 90 N m
Bending moment in pedal arm at section C
My-axis:
a Frider Mc = 0
Twisting moment in pedal arm at section C
Mx-axis:
b Frider Tc = 0
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach,4th Ed.
3-4-1
PROBLEM 3-4 Statement:
The trailer hitch from Figure 1-1 has loads applied as shown in Figure P3-2. The tongue weight of 100 kg acts downward and the pull force of 4905 N acts horizontally. Using the dimensions of the ball bracket in Figure 1-5 (p. 15), draw a free-body diagram of the ball bracket and find the tensile and shear loads applied to the two bolts that attach the bracket to the channel in Figure 1-1.
Given:
a 40 mm Mtongue 100 kg
b 31 mm Fpull 4.905 kN
c 70 mm t 19 mm
d 20 mm
Assumptions: 1. The nuts are just snug-tight (no pre-load), which is the worst case. 2. All reactions will be concentrated loads rather than distributed loads or pressures. Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-4 and Mathcad file P0304.
The weight on the tongue is Wtongue Mtongue g
Wtongue 0.981 kN
2. The FBD of the hitch and bracket assembly is shown in Figure 3-4. The known external forces that act on the ball are Fpull and Wtongue . The reactions on the bracket are at points C and D. The bolts at C provide tensile (Fc2x) and shear (Fc2y) forces, and the bracket resists rotation about point D where the reaction force Fd2 is applied by the channel to which the bracket is bolted. 3. Solving for the reactions by summing the horizontal and vertical forces and the moments about D:
Fx :
Fpull Fc2x Fd2 = 0
(1)
Fy :
Fc2y Wtongue = 0
(2)
MD :
Fc2x d Fpull ( a t b d ) Wtongue c = 0
(3)
W tongue 70 = c
1
F pull
1
40 = a 2
B
A
2
19 = t 31 = b
C
Fc2x
20 = d D
B
C D
Fd2 F c2y
FIGURE 3-4 Dimensions and Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-4
4.
Solving equation (3) for Fc2x
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach,4th Ed.
Fc2x 5.
Fpull ( a t b d ) Wtongue c d
(4)
Fd2 25.505 kN
(5)
Fc2y 0.981 kN
(6)
Solving (2) for Fc2y Fc2y Wtongue
7.
Fc2x 30.41 kN
Substituting into (1) and solving for Fd2 Fd2 Fc2x Fpull
6.
3-4-2
The loads applied to the two bolts that attach the bracket to the channel are: Axial force on two bolts
Fc2x 30.4 kN
Shear force on two bolts
Fc2y 0.98 kN
We assume that each bolt would carry one half of these loads.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-5-1
PROBLEM 3-5 Statement:
For the trailer hitch of Problem 3-4, determine the horizontal force that will result on the ball from accelerating a 2000-kg trailer to 60 m/sec in 20 sec.
Given:
Mass of trailer
Mtrailer 2000 kg
Final velocity
vf 60
Time to reach velocity
τ 20 sec
m sec
Assumptions: 1. Acceleration is constant. 2. The rolling resistance of the tires and the wheel bearings is negligible. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0305.
From elementary kinematics, the acceleration required is a
2.
vf
τ
a 3.00
m sec
(1) 2
Using Newton's second law to find the force required to accelerate the trailer, Fhitch Mtrailer a
Fhitch 6.00 kN
(2)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-6-1
PROBLEM 3-6 Statement:
For the trailer hitch of Problem 3-4, determine the horizontal force that will result on the ball from an impact between the ball and the tongue of the 2000-kg trailer if the hitch deflects 2.8 mm dynamically on impact. The tractor weighs 1000 kg. The velocity at impact is 0.3 m/sec.
Given:
Mass of trailer
Mtrailer 2000 kg
Dynamic deflection
δi 2.8 mm
Mass of tractor
Mtractor 1000 kg
Impact velocity
vi 0.3
m sec
Assumptions: 1. The tractor is the "struck member" because the hitch is on the tractor and it is the hitch that deflects. 2. Equations (3.9) and (3.10) can be used to model the impact. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0306.
The weight of the trailer (the "striking member") is Wtrailer Mtrailer g
2.
The correction factor, from equation (3-15), is 1
η 1
3.
Wtrailer 19.613 kN
Mtractor
η 0.857
3 Mtrailer
Eliminating E from equations (3.9a) and (3.10) and solving for the horizontal force on the ball Fi yields 1 2 Fi δi = η Mtrailer vi 2 2 1
Fi
η Mtrailer vi δi
2
Fi 55.1 kN
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-7-1
PROBLEM 3-7 Statement:
The piston of an internal-combustion engine is connected to its connecting rod with a "wrist pin." Find the force on the wrist pin if the 0.5-kg piston has an acceleration of 2 500 g.
Given:
Mass of piston
Mpiston 0.5 kg
Acceleration of piston
a piston 2500 g
Assumptions: The force on the wrist pin due to the weight of the piston is very small compared with the acceleration force. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0307.
The acceleration in m/s is
4
a piston 2.452 10
m sec
2.
2
Using Newton's Second Law expressed in equation (3.1a), the force on the wrist pin is Fwristpin Mpiston a piston
Fwristpin 12.258 kN
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
PROBLEM 3-8
3-8-1
_____
Statement:
A cam-follower system similar to that shown in Figure 3-15 has a mass m = 1 kg, a spring constant k = 1000 N/m, and a damping coefficient d = 19.4 N-s/m. Find the undamped and damped natural frequencies of this system.
Units:
cps := 2 ⋅ π⋅ rad⋅ sec
Given:
Mass
−1
M := 1 ⋅ kg,
Spring constant
−1
k := 1000⋅ N ⋅ m
−1
Damping coefficient d := 19.4⋅ N ⋅ s⋅ m Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-15 and Mathcad file P0308.
Calculate the undamped natural frequency using equation 3.4.
ωn := 2.
k
ωn = 31.6
M
rad sec
ωn = 5.03 cps
Calculate the undamped natural frequency using equation 3.7.
ωd :=
d − M 2⋅ M k
2
ωd = 30.1
rad sec
ωd = 4.79 cps
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0308.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-9-1
PROBLEM 3-9 Statement:
A ViseGrip plier-wrench is drawn to scale in Figure P3-3. Scale the drawing for dimensions. Find the forces acting on each pin and member of the assembly for an assumed clamping force of P = 4000 N in the position shown. What force F is required to keep it in the clamped position shown?
Given:
Clamping force Dimensions
P 4.00 kN a 50.0 mm b 55.0 mm c 39.5 mm d 22.0 mm
e 28.0 mm f 26.9 mm g 2.8 mm h 21.2 mm
α 21.0 deg β 129.2 deg
Assumptions: Links 3 and 4 are in a toggle position, i.e., the pin that joins links 3 and 4 is in line with the pins that join 1 with 4 and 2 with 3. Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-9 and Mathcad file P0309.
The FBDs of the assembly and each individual link are shown in Figure 3-9. The dimensions, as scaled from Figure P3-3 in the text, are given above and are shown on the link FBDs. 4
F
P 1
2
3
P
F 55.0 = b
50.0 = a
39.5 = c
F
F14 22.0 = d
129.2°
1
4 F34
F41
F21
P
28.0 = e
F43
F12
3 F23
F32
P
2.8 = g
21.2 = h
2
F 26.9 = f
FIGURE 3-9 Free Body Diagrams for Problem 3-9
2.
Looking first at Part 3, we see that it is a three-force body. Therefore, the lines of action of the three forces must intersect at a point. But, since Parts 3 and 4 are in a toggle position, F43 and F23 are colinear, which means that their x- and y-components must be equal and opposite, leading to the conclussion that F = 0.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0309.xmcd 3-9-1 mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3.
3-9-2
Now, looking at Part 1, we see that (for F = 0) it is also a three-force body, as is Part 2. In fact, the forces on Part 1 are identical to those on Part 2. Solving for the unknown reactions on Parts 1 and 2, Fx:
F41 cos( 180 deg α) F21 cos( β 180 deg) = 0
(a)
Fy:
F41 sin( 180 deg α) F21 sin( β 180 deg) P = 0
(b)
Solving equation (a) for F21 F21 =
F41 cos( 180 deg α)
(c)
cos( β 180 deg)
Substituting equation (c) into (b) F41 sin( 180 deg α)
F41 cos( 180 deg α) cos( β 180 deg)
sin( β 180 deg) P = 0
(d)
Solving equation (d) for F41 P
F41 sin( 180 deg α)
F21
cos( 180 deg α) cos( β 180 deg)
sin( β 180 deg)
F41 cos( 180 deg α)
F41 5.1 kN
cos( β 180 deg) F21 7.5 kN
Checking moment balance on Part 1, F41 sin( α) c F21 sin( β 90 deg) d P a 0 kN m The result is, within the accuracy of the scaled dimensions, zero as it must be. 4.
5.
6.
The x and y components of the pin forces on Part 1 are F41x F41 cos( 180 deg α)
F41x 4.749 kN
F41y F41 sin( 180 deg α)
F41y 1.823 kN
F21x F21 cos( β 180 deg)
F21x 4.749 kN
F21y F21 sin( β 180 deg)
F21y 5.823 kN
The forces on the pins at the ends of Part 4 are F14 F41
F14 5.1 kN
F34 F14
F34 5.1 kN
The forces on the pins at the ends of Part 3 are F43 F34
F43 5.1 kN
F23 F43
F23 5.1 kN
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0309.xmcd 3-9-2 mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
7.
3-9-3
The forces on the pins at the ends of Part 2 are F12 F21
F12 7.5 kN
F32 F23
F32 5.1 kN
Checking moment equilibrium on Part 2, F12 ( e cos( β 90 deg) g sin( β 90 deg) ) 0 kN m F32 ( h cos( α) f sin( α) ) which is zero, as it must be.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0309.xmcd 3-9-3 mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-10-1
PROBLEM 3-10 Statement:
Given:
An overhung diving board is shown in Figure P3-4a. Find the reaction forces and construct the shear and moment diagrams for this board with a 100 kg person standing at the free end. Determine the maximum shear force, maximum moment and their locations. Beam length Distance to support Mass at free end
L 2000 mm a 700 mm M 100 kg
2000 = L R1
Assumptions: The weight of the beam is negligible compared to the applied load and so can be ignored.
P
R2 700 = a
Solution:
See Figure 3-10 and Mathcad file P0310. FIGURE 3-10A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-10
1. From inspection of Figure 3-10, write the load function equation q(x) = -R1-1 + R2-1 - P-1 2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -R10 + R20 - P0 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -R11 + R21 - P1 4. Determine the magnitude of the force, P
P M g
P 980.7 N
5. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 R1 P
La a
R2 P R1 6. Define the range for x
V = R1 R2 P = 0
M = R1 L R2 ( L a ) = 0
R1 1821 N R2 2802 N
x 0 in 0.005 L L
7. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 8. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 in) R2 S ( x a ) P S ( x L) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 in) x R2 S ( x a ) ( x a ) P S ( x L) ( x L) © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-10-2
9. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. 1000
Shear Diagram
0 V ( x) N 1000
2000
0
500
1000
1500
2000
x mm 0
Moment Diagram
375 M ( x) Nm
750
1125
1500
0
500
1000
1500
2000
x mm
FIGURE 3-10B Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-10
10. The maximum value of the shear force ocuurs throughout the distance from x = 0 to x = a and is R1 1821 N 11. Find the maximum value of the bending moment by determining the value of x where the shear is zero. Inspection of the shear diagram shows that this occurs at x = a. Mmax M ( a )
Mmax 1275 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-11-1
PROBLEM 3-11 Statement:
Given:
Determine the impact force and dynamic deflection that will result when the 100-kg person in Problem 3-10 jumps up 250 mm and lands back on the board. Assume that the board weighs 29 kg and deflects 131 mm statically when the person stands on it. Find the reaction forces and construct the shear and moment diagrams for this dynamic loading. Determine the maximum shear force, maximum moment and their locations along the length of the board. Beam length
L 2000 mm
Distance to support
a 700 mm
Mass of person
mpers 100 kg
Mass of board
mboard 29 kg
Static deflection
δst 131 mm
Height of jump
h 250 mm
2000 = L R1
R2 700 = a
Assumptions: Equation (3.15) can be used to approximate a mass correction factor. Solution:
Fi
FIGURE 3-11A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-11
See Figure 3-11 and Mathcad file P0311.
1. The person is the moving object and the board is the struck object. The mass ratio to be used in equation (3.15) for the correction factor is massratio
mpers
massratio 3.448
mboard
2. From equation (3.15), the correction factor is 1
η 1
η 0.912
1 3 massratio
3. The weight of the moving mass is
Wpers mpers g
Wpers 0.981 kN
4. The dynamic force is found by solving equation (3.14) for Fi.
Fi Wpers 1
1
2 η h
Fi 3.056 kN
δst
From this we see that the dynamic force ratio is
Fi Wpers
3.12
5. From inspection of Figure 3-11, write the load function equation q(x) = -R1-1 + R2-1 - Fi-1 6. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -R10 + R20 - Fi0 7. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -R11 + R21 - Fi1 © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-11-2
8. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. V = R1 R2 Fi = 0
At x = L+, V = M = 0 R1 Fi
L a
M = R1 L R2 ( L a ) = 0
R1 5676 N
a
R2 Fi R1
R2 8733 N
x 0 in 0.005 L L
9. Define the range for x
10. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 11. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 in) R2 S ( x a ) Fi S ( x L) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 in) x R2 S ( x a ) ( x a ) Fi S ( x L) ( x L) 12. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. Shear Diagram
V ( x) kN
Moment Diagram
4
0
2
1
0
M ( x)
2 kN m
2
3
4 6
0
0.5
1
1.5
2
4
0
0.5
1
x
x
m
m
1.5
2
FIGURE 3-11B Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-11
13. The maximum value of the shear force ocuurs throughout the distance from x = 0 to x = a and is R1 5676 N 14. Find the maximum value of the bending moment by determining the value of x where the shear is zero. Inspection of the shear diagram shows that this occurs at x = a. Mmax M ( a )
Mmax 3973 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-12-1
PROBLEM 3-12 Statement:
Given:
An overhung diving board is shown in Figure P3-4b. Find the reaction forces and construct the shear and moment diagrams for this board with a 100 kg person standing at the free end. Determine the maximum shear force, maximum moment and their locations. Beam length
L 1300 mm
Mass at free end
M 100 kg
Assumptions: 1. The weight of the beam is negligible compared to the applied load and so can be ignored. Solution:
2000 1300 = L P
M1
R1
See Figure 3-12 and Mathcad file P0312. 700
1. From inspection of Figure 3-12, write the load function equation q(x) = -M1-2 + R1-1 - P-1
FIGURE 3-12A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-12
2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -M1-1 + R10 - P0 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -M10 + R11 - P1 4. Determine the magnitude of the force, P
P M g
P 980.7 N
5. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0
V = R1 P = 0
R1 P
R1 981 N
M1 R1 L
M1 1275 m N
6. Define the range for x
M = M1 R1 L = 0
x 0 in 0.005 L L
7. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 8. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 mm) P S ( x L) M ( x) M1 S ( x 0 mm) R1 S ( x 0 mm) ( x 0 mm) P S ( x L) ( x L) 9. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-12-2
1000
Shear Diagram
800
V ( x) N
600 400 200 0
0
0.5
1
1.5
2
1.5
2
x m 0
Moment Diagram
300
M ( x) Nm
600 900 1200 1500
0
0.5
1 x m
FIGURE 3-12B Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-12
10. The maximum value of the shear force ocuurs throughout the distance from x = 0 to x = L and is R1 981 N 11. Find the maximum value of the bending moment by determining the value of x where the shear is zero. Inspection of the shear diagram shows that this occurs at x = 0. Mmax M ( 0 mm)
Mmax 1275 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-13-1
PROBLEM 3-13 Statement:
Given:
Determine the impact force and dynamic deflection that will result when a 100-kg person jumps up 25 cm and lands back on the board. Assume the board weighs 19 kg and deflects 8.5 cm statically when the person stands on it. Find the reaction forces and construct the shear and moment diagrams for this dynamic loading. Determine the maximum shear force, maximum moment, and their locations along the length of the board. Total board length
b 2000 mm
Supported length
a 700 mm
Mass of board
mboard 19 kg
Static board deflection
δstat 85 mm
Mass of person
mperson 100 kg
Height of jump
h 250 mm
2000 1300 = L Fi
M1
Assumptions: 1. The board can be modelled as a cantilever beam with maximum shear and moment at the edge of the support. Solution: 1.
FIGURE 3-13A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-13
The person impacts the board upon landing. Thus, the board is the struck object and the person is the striking object. To determine the force exerted by the person we will first need to know the impact correction factor from equation (3.15). 1 1
η 0.94
mboard
(1)
3 mperson
We can now use equation (3.14) to determine the impact force, Fi,
Fi mperson g 1
3.
700
See Figure 3-13 and Mathcad file P0313.
η
2.
R1
1
2 η h
δstat
Fi 3.487 kN
(2)
Write an equation for the load function in terms of equations 3.17 and integrate the resulting function twice using equations 3.18 to obtain the shear and moment functions. Note use of the unit doublet function to represent the moment at the wall. For the beam in Figure 3-13, q(x) = -M1-2 + R1-1 - Fi-1
(3)
V(x) = -M1-1 + R10 - Fi0 + C1
(4)
M(x) = -M10 + R11 - Fi1 + C1x+ C2
(5)
The reaction moment M1 at the wall is in the z direction and the forces R1 and Fi are in the y direction in equation (4). All moments in equation (5) are in the z direction. 4.
Because the reactions have been included in the loading function, the shear and moment diagrams both close to zero at each end of the beam, making C1 = C2 = 0.
5.
The reaction force R1 and the reaction moment M1 can be calculated from equations (4) and (5) respectively
by substituting the boundary conditions x = l+, V = 0, M = 0. Note that we can substitute l for l+ since their difference is vanishingly small. © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-13-2
l b a
Unsupported beam length
l 1300 mm
V(l) = -M1-1 + R10 - Fi0 = 0 V = R1 Fi = 0
(6)
R1 Fi
R1 3.487 kN
M(l) = -M10 + R11 - Fi1 = 0 M = M1 R1 l Fi ( l l) = 0
(7)
M1 R1 l
M1 4533 N m
6. To generate the shear and moment functions over the length of the beam, equations (4) and (5) must be evaluated for a range of values of x from 0 to l, after substituting the above values of C1, C2, R1, and M1 in them. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than the dummy variable z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. It will have the same effect as the singularity function. Range of x
x 0 in 0.005 l l
Unit step function
S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 )
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. 0
V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 in) ( x 0 ) Fi S ( x l) ( x l) 0
0 1
M ( x) M1 S ( x 0 in) ( x 0 ) R1 S ( x 0 in) ( x 0 ) Fi S ( x l ) ( x l)
(8)
1
Plot the shear and moment diagrams (see below). Shear Diagram
Moment Diagram 0 1
3 V ( x) kN
M ( x) 2
kN m 3
1
0
2
4
0
0.5
1
5
0
0.5
1
x
x
m
m
1.5
7. The graphs show that the shear force and the moment are both largest at x = 0. The function values of these points can be calculated from equations (4) and (5) respectively by substituting x = 0 and evaluating the singularity functions: Vmax = V(0) = R1<0 - 0>0 - Fi<0 - l>0 = R1
(9)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Vmax R1
3-13-3 Vmax 3.49 kN
M.max = M(0) = -M1<0 - 0>0 + R1<0 - 0>1 - Fi<0 - l>1 = -M1 Mmax M1
(10)
Mmax 4533 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-14-1
PROBLEM 3-14 Statement:
Units: Given:
Figure P3-5 shows a child's toy called a pogo stick. The child stands on the pads, applying half her weight on each side. She jumps off the ground, holding the pads up against her feet, and bounces along with the spring cushioning the impact and storing energy to help each rebound. Find the natural frequency of the system, the static deflection of the spring with the child standing still, and the dynamic force and deflection when the child lands after jumping 2 in off the ground.
blob :=
lbf ⋅ sec
2
in
Child's weight
Wc := 60⋅ lbf
Spring constant
k := 100⋅ lbf ⋅ in
Pogo stick weight
Wp := 5 ⋅ lbf
Height of drop
h := 2 ⋅ in
−1
Assumptions: 1. An approximate energy method will be acceptable. 2. The correction factor for energy dissipation will be applied. Solution:
See Figure 3-14 and Mathcad file P0314.
Fi /2
1. Find the natural frequency of the (child/spring) system. Mass of child (striker)
m :=
Mass of stick (struck)
mb :=
Natural frequency
ω :=
f :=
Wc
Fi /2
m = 0.155⋅ blob
g Wp
mb = 0.013⋅ blob
g k
ω = 25.367⋅
m
rad sec
P
ω 2⋅ π
f = 4.037⋅ Hz FIGURE 3-14 Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-14
2. The static deflection of the spring with the child standing still is Static deflection of spring
δst :=
Wc
δst = 0.6⋅ in
k
3. Determine the mass ratio correction factor from equation (3.15): Correction factor
1
η := 1+
mb
η = 0.973
3⋅ m
4. Using equation (3.14), determine the dynamic force.
Fi := Wc⋅ 1 +
1+
2 ⋅ η⋅ h
δst
Fi = 224⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-15-1
PROBLEM 3-15 Statement:
A pen plotter imparts a constant acceleration of 2.5 m/sec2 to the pen assembly, which travels in a straight line across the paper. The moving pen assembly weighs 0.5 kg. The plotter weighs 5 kg. What coefficient of friction is needed between the plotter feet and the table top on which it sits to prevent the plotter from moving when the pen accelerates?
Given:
Acceleration of pen ass'y a 2.5 m sec Mass of pen ass'y mpen 0.5 kg mplot 5 kg
Mass of plotter Solution: 1.
2
See Mathcad file P0315.
The force imparted to the pen assembly by the internal drive mechanism must be reacted at the table top by the plotter feet. The horizontal force at the feet will be equal to the force on the pen assembly and must be less than or equal to the maximum friction force, which is the product of the coefficient of friction and the normal force, which is the weight of the plotter. Horizontal driving force on pen ass'y
Fpen mpen a
Fpen 1.25 N
Weight of plotter
Wplot mplot g
Wplot 49.033 N
Minimum coefficient of friction
μ
Fpen Wplot
μ 0.025
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-16-1
PROBLEM 3-16 Statement:
A track to guide bowling balls is designed with two round rods as shown in Figure P3-6. The rods are not parallel to one another but have a small angle between them. The balls roll on the rods until they fall between them and drop onto another track. The angle between the rods is varied to cause the ball to drop at different locations. Each rod's unsupported length is 30 in and the angle between them is 3.2 deg. The balls are 4.5 in dia and weigh 2.5 lb. The center distance between the 1-in-dia rods is 4.2 in at the narrow end. Find the distance from the narrow end at which the ball drops through and determine the worst-case shear and moment maximum for the rods as the ball rolls a distance from the narrow end that is 98% of the distance to drop. Assume that the rods are simply supported at each end and have zero deflection under the applied loading. (Note that assuming zero deflection is unrealistic. This assumption will be relaxed in the next chapter after deflection has been discussed.)
Given:
Unsupported rod length Half-angle between rods Bowling ball diameter
Solution:
See Figure 3-16 and Mathcad file P0316.
1.
L 30 in α 1.6 deg D 4.5 in
Bowling ball weight Rod diameter Half width of rod gap
Calculate the distance between the ball and rod centers. Distance between centers
h
D d 2
A
W 2.5 lbf d 1.0 in c 2.1 in
A
h 2.75 in
c TOP VIEW
F
u
x W/2 F
SECTION A-A
width(x) (a) Distance between the roll axis and the rod axis.
(b) Partial FBD of the bowling ball.
FIGURE 3-16 Dimensions and Free Body Diagrams for Problem 3-16
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 2.
3-16-2
Let x be the distance along the roll axis, and u be the corresponding distance to the point of contact between the ball and rods, measured along the rods. Then the distance from the center plane of the ball to the center of a rod as shown in Figure 3-16(a) is, width( x) c cos( α) x sin( α)
(1)
And the distance from the narrow end to the point at which the ball drops (assuming rigid rods) is xdrop
h c cos( α)
xdrop 23.31 in
sin( α)
The distance along the rod corresponding to xdrop is u drop
3.
xdrop h sin( α)
The angle made by a line through the ball-rod centers and the horizontal plane (see Figure 3-16b) is
θ ( x) acos
4.
width( x) h
When x = 0, this is
θ0 θ ( 0 in)
θ0 40.241 deg
When x = 0.98xdrop, this is
θ98% θ 0.98 xdrop
θ98% 5.577 deg
The loading on the ball is symmetric about its center plane along the x-axis. Figure 3-16(b) shows a FBD of one half of the ball with the internal forces along the plane of symmetry due to the reaction at the other rod omitted. With these forces omitted we may only sum forces in the vertical direction.
Fy :
F sin( θ ) μ F cos( θ )
F=
5.
u drop 23.24 in
cos( α)
W 2
(2)
=0
W
(3)
2 ( sin( θ ) μ cos( θ ) )
The ball will drop through the rods when is zero. If there were no friction force present ( = 0) then F would become very large as approached zero. The presence of the friction term in the denominator of equation (3) limits F to finite values. However, with the assumption that the rods are rigid, there is no way for the rods to provide a normal force when reaches zero. Thus, we will need to limit the range of for this analysis. Let
μ 0
Then
xmax
u max Fmax
and
θmin θ98%
h cos θmin c cos( α) sin( α) xmax h sin( α) cos( α) W
2 sin θmin
xmax 22.84 in
u max 22.77 in Fmax 12.86 lbf
(4)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
6.
3-16-3
Determine the worst-case shear and moment maximum for the rods as the ball rolls along their length from Figure B-2(a) in Appendix B where a in the figure is u max. Then,
Mmax Fmax u max 1
u max L
Mmax 70.6 in lbf
(5)
For the shear, we must find the reactions, which are
R1 Fmax 1 R2 Fmax R1
u max L
R1 3.10 lbf R2 9.76 lbf
The maximum absolute value of shear is the larger of these two. Thus Vmax R2
Vmax 9.8 lbf
(6)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-17-1
PROBLEM 3-17 Statement:
A pair of ice tongs is shown in Figure P3-7. The ice weighs 50 lb and is 10 in wide across the tongs. The distance between the handles is 4 in, and the mean radius r of a tong is 6 in. Draw free-body diagrams of the two tongs and find all forces acting on them. Determine the bending moment at point A.
Given:
Weight of ice Distances
W 50 lbf a x 11.0 in
a y 6.0 in
b x 5.0 in
b y 12.0 in
cx 2.0 in
cy 3.5 in
Assumptions: Assume that the horizontal force at C (the handle) is zero, thus Fc 0 lbf Solution:
(1)
See Figure 3-17 and Mathcad file P0317.
F
F
F C FC O 11.0 = ax
3.5 = cy
FO 2.0 = cx
A
12.0 = by 5.0 = bx
FB B W/2
W FIGURE 3-17A Free Body Diagrams for Problem 3-17
1.
Summing forces and moments on a single tong (see FBD above right).
Fx
FO FB FC = 0
Fy
W
MC
FO cy FB b y cy
2
(2)
F=0
(3) W 2
b x cx = 0
2.
From equations (1) and (2), FO = FB
3.
Eliminating FO from equations (4) and (5) and solving for FB FB
W b x cx 2 by
(4) (5)
FB 14.58 lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-17-2
F 4. From equation (3), the vertical force on one handle is F
W
FC
F 25 lbf
2
O
5. From Figure 3-17B we see that, at any section that we might take through the tong, there will be an internal moment, shear force, and axial force present. The bending moment will be a maximum at point A because it is the fartherest point from the centroid of the system. Summing forces and moments:
Fx
C
-FDs cos + FDn sin (6) + FO = 0
11.0 = ax
A
3.5 = cy
FO 2.0 = cx
D
FDs M D FDn FIGURE 3-17B Free Body Diagram with section at D for Problem 3-17
Fy
-FDs sin - FDn cos +F=0 (7)
MO
F cx - M D - (FDs cos + FDn sin )(ay + rc sin ) + (FDs sin + FDn cos )[ax - rc (1 - cos)] = 0 (8)
6.
Solving equations (6) and (7) for FDs and FDn FDn = F cos( θ ) FO sin( θ )
7.
FDs =
FDn sin( θ ) FO cos( θ )
The maximum value of MD will occur at = 0 deg. At = 0 deg, FO FB FDn F
FDn 25 lbf
FDs FO
FDs 14.58 lbf
MD F cx FDs a y FDn a x
MD 237.5 lbf in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-18-1
PROBLEM 3-18 Statement:
A tractor-trailer tipped over while negotiating an on-ramp to the New York Thruway. The road has a 50-ft radius at that point and tilts 3 deg toward the outside of the curve. The 45-ft-long by 8-ft-wide by 8.5-ft-high trailer box (13 ft from ground to top) was loaded 44 415 lb of paper rolls in two rows by two high as shown in Figure P3-8. The rolls are 40-in-dia by 38-in-long and weigh about 900 lb each. They are wedged against rolling backward but not against sliding sidewards. The empty trailer weighed 14 000 lb. The driver claims that he was traveling at less than 15 mph and that the load of paper shifted inside the trailer, struck the trailer sidewall, and tipped the truck. The paper company that loaded the truck claims the load was properly stowed and would not shift at that speed. Independent test of the coefficient of friction between similar paper rolls and a similar trailer floor give a value of 0.43 +/- 0.08. The composite center of gravity of the loaded trailer is estimated to be 7.5 ft above the road. Determine the truck speed that would cause the truck to just begin to tip and the speed at which the rolls will just begin to slide sidways. What do you think caused the accident?
Given:
Weight of paper
Wp := 44415⋅ lbf
Weight of trailer
Wt := 14000⋅ lbf
Radius of curve Nominal coefficient of friction
r := 50⋅ ft μnom := 0.43
Coefficient of friction uncertainty
u μ := 0.08
Trailer width Height of CG from pavement
w := 8 ⋅ ft h := 7.5⋅ ft
Assumptions: 1. The paper rolls act as a monolith since they are tightly strapped together with steel bands. 2. The tractor has about 15 deg of potential roll freedom versus the trailer due to their relative angle in plan during the turn combined with the substantial pitch freedom in the fifth wheel. So the trailer can tip independently of the tractor. 3. The outside track width of the trailer tires is equal to the width of the trailer. Solution:
See Figure 3-18 and Mathcad file P0318.
1. First, calculate the location of the trailer's CG with respect to the outside wheel when it is on the reverse-banked curve. From Figure 3-18A, Tilt angle
θ := 3 ⋅ deg
a := h ⋅ tan( θ )
a = 0.393⋅ ft
b :=
w 2
−a
xbar := b ⋅ cos( θ ) ybar := b⋅ sin( θ ) +
3°
b = 3.607⋅ ft
7.500'
h cos( θ )
ybar = 7.699⋅ ft
a
The coordinates of the CG of the loaded trailer with respect to the lower outside corner of the tires are: xbar = 3.602⋅ ft
ybar
xbar = 3.602⋅ ft
ybar = 7.699⋅ ft
b xbar 4.000'
FIGURE 3-18A Location of CG for Problem 3-18
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 3-18-2 2. The trailer is on the verge of tipping over when the copule due to centrifugal force is equal to the couple formed by the weight of the loaded trailer acting through its CG and the vertical reaction at the outside edge of the tires. At this instant, it is assumed that the entire weight of the trailer is reacted at the outside tires with the inside tires carrying none of the weight. Any increase in tangential velocity of the tractor and trailer will result in tipping. Summing moments about the tire edge (see Figure 3-18B),
ΣM
Fw⋅ xbar − Fc⋅ ybar = 0
(1)
where Fc is the centrifugal force due to the normal acceleration as the tractor and trailer go through the curve. The normal acceleration is a tip =
vtip
Fc
2
(2)
r
and the force necessary to keep the tractor trailer following a circular path is Fc = mtot⋅ a tip
Fw ybar (3)
Rx
where mtot is the total mass of the trailer and its payload. Combining equations (2) and (3) and solving for vtip, we have vtip =
Fc⋅ r
Ry xbar (4)
mtot
FIGURE 3-18B FBD of Trailer on the Verge of Tipping
or, vtip =
3.
Fc⋅ r⋅ g
(5)
Fw
Calculate the minimum tipping velocity of the tractor/trailer. From equations (1) and (5), Total weight
Fw := Wt + Wp
Centrifugal force required to tip the trailer
Fc :=
Minimum tipping speed
vtip :=
xbar ybar
⋅ Fw
Fc⋅ r⋅ g Fw
Fw = 58415⋅ lbf Fc = 27329⋅ lbf
vtip = 18.7⋅ mph
Thus, with the assumptions that we have made, the trailer would not begin to tip over until it reached a speed of vtip = 18.7⋅ mph 4.
The load will slip when the friction force between the paper rolls and the trailer floor is no longer sufficient to react the centrifugal force on the paper rolls. Looking at the FBD of the paper rolls in Figure 3-18C, we see that Normal force between paper and floor
Fn = Wp⋅ cos( θ ) − Fcp ⋅ sin( θ )
(6)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-18-3
Tangential force tending to slide the paper Ft = Wp⋅ sin( θ ) + Fcp ⋅ cos( θ )
(7)
Fcp
Centrifugal force on the paper
Fcp =
Wp g
Wp
2
⋅ as =
W p vs ⋅ g r
(8)
Ft Fn
But, the maximum friction force is (9)
Ff = μ ⋅ Fn = Ft
FIGURE 3-18C FBD of Paper on the Verge of Sliding
Substituting equation (9) into (7), then combining (6) and (7) to eliminate Fn, and solving for Fcp yields
Fcp =
Wp⋅ ( μ ⋅ cos( θ ) − sin( θ ) )
(10)
μ ⋅ sin( θ ) + cos( θ )
Substituting equation (10) into (8), to eliminate Fcp , and solving for vs yields
vs =
5.
( μ ⋅ cos( θ ) − sin( θ ) ) μ ⋅ sin( θ ) + cos( θ ) ⋅ r⋅ g
(11)
Use the upper and lower limit on the coefficient of friction to determine an upper and lower limit on the speed necessary to cause sliding. Maximium coefficient
μmax := μnom + u μ
μmax = 0.51
Minimium coefficient
μmin := μnom − uμ
μmin = 0.35
Maximum velocity to cause sliding
vsmax :=
( μmax ⋅ cos( θ ) − sin( θ ) ) μ ⋅ sin( θ ) + cos( θ ) ⋅ r⋅ g max
vsmax = 18.3⋅ mph
Minimum velocity to cause sliding
vsmin :=
6.
( μmin ⋅ cos( θ ) − sin( θ ) ) μ ⋅ sin( θ ) + cos( θ ) ⋅ r⋅ g min
vsmin = 14.8⋅ mph
This very rough analysis shows that , if the coefficient of friction was at or near the low end of its measured value, the paper load could slide at a tractor/trailer speed of 15 mph, which would lead to the trailer tipping over. In any case, it appears that the paper load would slide before the truck would tip with the load in place.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-19-1
PROBLEM 3-19 Statement:
Assume that the CG of the paper rolls in Problem 3-18 is 2.5 ft above the floor of the trailer. At what speed on the same curve will the pile of rolls tip over (not slide) with respect to the trailer?
Given:
Weight of paper
Wp := 44415⋅ lbf
Radius of curve Paper roll length Height of CG from floor
r := 50⋅ ft L := 38⋅ in h := 2.5⋅ ft
L = 3.167⋅ ft
Assumptions: The paper rolls act as a single, lumped mass and tip about one corner where they are braced against sliding. The brace provides no moment support. Solution:
See Figure 3-19 and Mathcad file P0319.
1. First, calculate the location of the paper's CG with respect to the outside corner when it is on the reverse-banked curve. From Figure 3-19, Tilt angle
θ := 3⋅ deg
a := h⋅ tan ( θ)
a = 0.131⋅ ft
b := L − a
b = 3.036⋅ ft
xbar := b ⋅ cos ( θ)
xbar = 3.031⋅ ft
ybar := b⋅ sin ( θ) +
Fcp 2.500' Wp a
ybar
Rx b xbar R y 3.167'
h FIGURE 3-19
cos ( θ)
FBD of Paper on the Verge of Tipping
ybar = 2.662⋅ ft The coordinates of the CG of the paper with respect to the lower outside corner are: xbar = 3.031⋅ ft 2.
ybar = 2.662⋅ ft
The paper is on the verge of tipping over when the couple due to centrifugal force is equal to the couple formed by the weight of the paper acting through its CG and the vertical reaction at the outside edge of the rolls. At this instant, it is assumed that the entire weight of the paper is reacted at the outside corner. Any increase in tangential velocity of the tractor and trailer will result in tipping. Summing moments about the outside corner nearest the floor (see Figure 3-19),
ΣM
Wp⋅ xbar − Fcp ⋅ ybar = 0
(1)
where Fcp is the centrifugal force due to the normal acceleration as the tractor and trailer go through the curve. The normal acceleration is a tip =
vtip
2
(2)
r
and the force necessary to keep the tractor trailer following a circular path is Fcp = mp⋅ a tip
(3)
where mp is the mass of the paper. Combining equations (2) and (3) and solving for vtip, we have
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. vtip =
3-19-2
Fcp ⋅ r
(4)
mp
or, vtip =
3.
Fcp ⋅ r⋅ g
(5)
Wp
Calculate the minimum paper tipping velocity of the tractor/trailer. From equations (1) and (5), Centrifugal force required to tip the paper
Fcp :=
Minimum tipping speed
vtip :=
xbar ybar
⋅ Wp
Fcp ⋅ r⋅ g Wp
Fcp = 50574⋅ lbf
vtip = 29.2⋅ mph
Thus, with the assumptions that we have made, the paper would not begin to tip over until the tractor/trailor reached a speed of vtip = 29.2⋅ mph
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-20-1
PROBLEM 3-20 Statement:
Assume that the load of paper rolls in Problem 3-18 will slide sideways at a truck speed of 20 mph on the curve in question. Estimate the impact force of the cargo against the trailer wall. The force-deflection characteristic of the trailer wall has been measured as approximately 400 lb/in.
Given:
Weight of paper
Wp := 44415⋅ lbf
Weight of trailer
Wt := 14000⋅ lbf
Speed of tractor/trailer
vt := 20⋅ mph
Radius of curve Trailer width Paper roll length
r := 50⋅ ft w := 8 ⋅ ft L := 38⋅ in lbf k := 400 in
Trailer wall stiffness
L = 3.167⋅ ft
Assumptions: 1. The paper rolls act as a monolith since they are tightly strapped together with steel bands. 2. The worst case will result if friction between the floor and the paper is neglected. Solution: 1.
See Figure P3-8 and Mathcad file P0320.
Calculate the distance that the rolls will slide before impacting the wall. s :=
2.
1 2
vt
2
r
2
vi = 64.266⋅
in sec
With the paper as the moving mass and the trailer as the stationary or struck mass, calculate the correction factor using equation (3.15) 1 1+
η = 0.905
Wt 3 ⋅ Wp
Calculate the static deflection caused by the paper against the trailer wall.
δst := 6.
sec
2⋅ a p⋅ s
η :=
5.
in
a p = 206.507⋅
From elementary particle dynamics, estimate the velocity at impact due to the centripetal acceleration vi :=
4.
s = 10⋅ in
Determine the centripetal acceleration at 20 mph. a p :=
3.
⋅ ( w − 2⋅ L)
Wp
δst = 111.037⋅ in
k
Using equation (3.12), estimate the dynamic force of the paper rolls impacting the trailer wall.
Fi := Wp⋅ vi⋅
η g ⋅ δst
Fi = 13114⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-21-1
PROBLEM 3-21 Statement:
Figure P3-9 shows an automobile wheel with two common styles of lug wrench being used to tighten the wheel nuts, a single-ended wrench in (a), and a double-ended wrench in (b). In each case two hands are required to provide forces respectively at A and B as shown. The distance between points A and B is 1 ft in both cases. The wheel nuts require a torque of 70 ft-lb. Draw free body diagrams for both wrenches and determine the magnitudes of all forces and moments on each wrench. Is there any difference between the way these two wrenches perform their assigned task? Is one design better than the other? If so, why? Explain.
Given:
Distance between A and B Tightening torque
d AB := 1 ⋅ ft T := 70⋅ ft ⋅ lbf
Assumptions: 1. The forces exerted by the user's hands lie in a plane through the wrench that is also parallel to the plane of the wheel. 2. The applied torque is perpendicular to the plane of the forces. 3. By virtue of 1 and 2 above, this is a planar problem that can be described in a 2D FBD. Solution:
See Figure 3-21 and Mathcad file P0321.
1. Summing moments about the left end of the wrench (for either case)
12" = dAB F
T − F ⋅ d AB = 0 2. Solving for F T
F :=
T d AB
F = 70⋅ lbf
F (a) Single-ended Wrench
3. This result is the same for both wrenches. 12" = dAB
Is there any difference between the way these two wrenches perform their assigned task? No, they both require the same two-handed exertion of 70 lb from each hand. Is one design better than the other? If so, why? Explain. Design (b) has advantages over (a) because it is balanced about the wheel nut. This allows the user to spin the wrench once the nut is loosened. It is also slightly easier to apply the upward and downward forces (F) in a plane with design (b).
F
6"
T F (b) Double-ended Wrench
FIGURE 3-21 Free Body Diagrams for Problem 3-21
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-22-1
PROBLEM 3-22 Statement:
A roller-blade skate is shown in Figure P3-10. The polyurethane wheels are 72 mm dia. The skate-boot-foot combination weighs 2 kg. The effective "spring rate" of the person-skate subsystem is 6000 N/m. Find the forces on the wheels' axles for a 100-kg person landing a 0.5-m jump on one foot. (a) Assume all 4 wheels land simultaneously. (b) Assume that one wheel absorbs all the landing force.
Given:
Mass of struck member
Msys 2 kg
Stiffness of struck member
k 6000
N
Mass of striking member
m Mperson 100 kg
Height of drop
h 0.5 m
Assumptions: Equation (3.14) applies in this case. Solution: 1.
See Figure P3-10 and Mathcad file P0322.
The weight of the striking mass is Wperson Mperson g
2.
The static deflection of the subsystem is
δst 3.
Wperson
δst 163.444 mm
k
The correction factor is 1
η 1
4.
Wperson 980.7 N
η 0.993
Msys 3 Mperson
From equation (3.14), the force of impact is
Fi 1
1
2 η h
Wperson
δst
Fi 3.59 kN
(a) If this will be absorbed by 4 wheel axles, the force per axle is Fa
Fi
Fa 897 N
4
(b) If one wheel absorbs all force
Fb Fi
Fb 3.59 kN
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-23a-1
PROBLEM 3-23a Statement:
Given:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-11a. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-1. Beam length
L 1 m
Distance to distributed load
a 0.4 m
L b a
Distance to concentrated load b 0.6 m 1
Distributed load magnitude
w 200 N m
Concentrated load
F 500 N
F
w
R2
R1
Solution:
See Figures 3-23 and Mathcad file P0323a. FIGURE 3-23A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-23
1. From inspection of Figure P3-11a, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - w0 + w0 - F-1 + R2-1 2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - w1 + w1 - F0 + R20 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - w2/2 + w2/2 - F1 + R21 4. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 w ( L) w ( L a ) F R2 = 0 M = R 1 L R1
w 2
L
w 2
2
L
F L
w 2
2
( L a) F ( L b) = 0
( L b)
w 2 L
( L a)
2
R1 264 N
R2 w a F R1 5. Define the range for x
R2 316 N
x 0 m 0.005 L L
6. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 7. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) w S ( x 0 m) ( x) w S ( x a ) ( x a ) F S ( x b ) R2 S ( x L) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) x
w 2
2
S ( x 0 m) x
w 2
2
S ( x a ) ( x a ) F S ( x b ) ( x b )
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-23a-2
8. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. 400
Shear Diagram
200 V ( x) 0
N
200 400
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
Moment Diagram
150
100 M ( x) Nm 50
0
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
FIGURE 3-23aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-23a
9. Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax V ( b )
Vmax 316 N
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = b: Mmax M ( b )
Mmax 126.4 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-24a-1
PROBLEM 3-24a Statement: Given:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-11b. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-1. Beam length
L 1 m
Distance to distributed load
a 0.4 m
a
1
w 200 N m
Distributed load magnitude
F w
F 500 N
Concentrated load Solution:
L
See Figures 3-24 and Mathcad file P0324a.
1. From inspection of Figure P3-11b, write the load function equation
M1 R1
FIGURE 3-24A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-24
q(x) = -M1-2 + R1-1 - w0 - F-1 2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -M1-1 + R10 - w1 - F0 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -M10 + R11 - w2/2 - F1 4. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 [ w ( L a ) F ] = 0 M = M1 R1 L
w 2
2
( L a) = 0
R1 w ( L a ) F M1
w 2
5. Define the range for x
R1 620 N
2
( L a ) R1 L
M1 584 N m
x 0 m 0.005 L L
6. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 7. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) w S ( x a ) ( x a ) F S ( x L) M ( x) M1 R1 S ( x 0 m) x
w 2
2
S ( x a ) ( x a ) F S ( x L) ( x L)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-24a-2
8. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. Shear Diagram 600 V ( x) N
400 200 0
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
0.6
0.8
x m
Moment Diagram
0
150 M ( x) Nm
300
450
600
0
0.2
0.4 x m
FIGURE 3-24aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-24a
9. Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax V ( 0 m)
Vmax 620 N
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = 0: Mmax M ( 0 m)
Mmax 584 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-25a-1
PROBLEM 3-25a Statement:
Given:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-11d. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-1. Beam length
L 1 m
Distance to distributed load
a 0.4 m
L b a
Distance to concentrated load b 0.6 m
F
1
Distributed load magnitude
w 200 N m
Concentrated load
F 500 N
w
R2
R1
Solution:
See Figures 3-25 and Mathcad file P0325a. FIGURE 3-25A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-25
1. From inspection of Figure P3-11c, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - w0 + R2-1 - F-1 2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - w1 + R20 - F0 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - w2/2 + R21 - F1 4. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 w ( L a ) R2 F = 0 M = R 1 L R1
w 2
2
( L a ) R2 ( L b ) = 0
w 2 ( L a ) F ( L b ) w ( L a ) ( L b ) b 2 1
R2 w ( L a ) F R1 5. Define the range for x
R1 353 N R2 973 N
x 0 m 0.005 L L
6. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 7. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) w S ( x a ) ( x a ) R2 S ( x b ) F S ( x L) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) x
w 2
2
S ( x a ) ( x a ) R2 S ( x b ) ( x b )
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-25a-2
8. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. 1
Shear Diagram
0.5 V ( x) 0
kN
0.5 1
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
Moment Diagram
0
75 M ( x) Nm
150
225
300
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
FIGURE 3-25aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-25a
9. Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax V ( b )
Vmax 580.0 N
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = a: Mmax M ( b )
Mmax 216 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-26a-1
PROBLEM 3-26a Statement: Given:
Solution:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-11d. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-1. Beam length
L 1 m
Distance to distributed load
a 0.4 m
Distance to reaction load
b 0.6 m
L b a
1
Distributed load magnitude
w 200 N m
Concentrated load
F 500 N
F w
R2
R1
See Figures 3-26 and Mathcad file P0326a.
FIGURE 3-26A Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-26
1. From inspection of Figure 3-26aA, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - w0 + R2-1 - F-1 2. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - w1 + R20 - F0 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - w2/2 + R21 - F1 4. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 w ( L a ) R2 F = 0 M = R 1 L R1
w 2
2
( L a ) R2 ( L b ) F ( L a ) = 0
w 2 ( L a ) F ( b a ) w ( L a ) ( L b ) b 2 1
R2 w ( L a ) F R1 5. Define the range for x
R1 147 N R2 473 N
x 0 m 0.005 L L
6. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 7. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) w S ( x a ) ( x a ) R2 S ( x b ) F S ( x a ) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) x
w 2
2
S ( x a ) ( x a ) R2 S ( x b ) ( x b ) F S ( x a ) ( x a )
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-26a-2
8. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. 500
Shear Diagram
250 V ( x) 0
N
250 500
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
Moment Diagram
60
40 M ( x) Nm
20
0
20
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
x m
FIGURE 3-26aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-26a
9. Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax V ( b 0.001 mm)
Vmax 393 N
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = a: Mmax M ( a )
Mmax 58.7 N m
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-27-1
PROBLEM 3-27 Statement:
A storage rack is to be designed to hold the paper roll of Problem 3-8 as shown in Figure P3-12. Determine the reactions and draw the shear and moment diagrams for the mandrel that extends 50% into the roll.
Given:
Paper roll dimensions
OD 1.50 m ID 0.22 m Lroll 3.23 m
Roll density
ρ 984 kg m
3
Assumptions: 1. The paper roll's weight creates a concentrated load acting at the tip of the mandrel. 2. The mandrel's root in the stanchion experiences a distributed load over its length of engagemen Solution:
See Figure 3-27 and Mathcad file P0327.
W 1. Determine the weight of the roll and the length of the mandrel. W
4
π
2
2
OD ID Lroll ρ g
W 53.9 kN
M1
Lm R1
Lm 0.5 Lroll
FIGURE 3-27 Lm 1.615 m
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-27
2. From inspection of Figure 3-27, write the load function equation q(x) = -M1-2 + R1-1 - W-1 3. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -M1-1 + R10 - W0 4. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -M10 + R11 - W1 5. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 W = 0
M = M1 R1 L = 0
R1 W
R1 53.895 kN
M1 R1 Lm
M1 87.040 kN m
6. Define the range for x
x 0 m 0.005 Lm Lm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-27-2
7. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 8. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) W S x Lm M ( x) M1 R1 S ( x 0 m) x W S x Lm x Lm 9. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. Shear Diagram 40 V ( x) kN 20
0
0
0.5
1
1.5
2
x m
Moment Diagram
20
1.615
10 M ( x) kN m
40
70
100
0
0.5
1
1.5
2
x m
FIGURE 3-27B Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-27
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-28-1
PROBLEM 3-28 Statement:
Figure P3-13 shows a forklift truck negotiating a 15 deg ramp to to drive onto a 4-ft-high loading platform. The truck weighs 5 000 lb and has a 42-in wheelbase. Determine the reactions and draw the shear and moment diagrams for the worst case of loading as the truck travels up the ramp.
Given:
Ramp angle Platform height Truck weight Truck wheelbase
θ 15 deg h 4 ft W 5000 lbf Lt 42 in
h 48 in
Assumptions: 1. The worst case is when the truck CG is located at the center of the beam's span. 2. Use a coordinate frame that has the x-axis along the long axis of the beam. 3. Ignore traction forces and the weight components along the x-axis of the beam. 4. There are two ramps, one for each side of the forklift. 5. The location of the CG in Figure P3-13 is 32 in from the front wheel and 10 in from the rear wheel. CGa 32 in Solution:
CGb 10 in
See Figure 3-28 and Mathcad file P0328.
L b a
CG a
y
CG b
R1 Fa
Wa
Fb
x Wb
R2
FIGURE 3-28A Dimensions and Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-28
1. Determine the length of the beam between supports and the distances a and b. Length of beam
With the CG at midspan, we have
and
L
h
L 15.455 ft
sin( θ )
a CGa =
L 2
a
L
b
L
2
2
CGa
a 5.061 ft
CGb
b 8.561 ft
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-28-2
2. The weight distribution on the wheels is determined from the distance from the front wheel to the CG. Each wheel weight is divided by 2 to get the weight on a single ramp. Weight on front wheel
Wa
CGb W Lt 2
Wa 595 lbf
Weight on rear wheel
Wb
W
Wb 1905 lbf
2
Wa
3. The normal force on the ramp at each wheel is adjusted for the ramp angle. Load at front wheel
Fa Wa cos( θ )
Fa 575 lbf
Load at rear wheel
Fb Wb cos( θ )
Fb 1840 lbf
4. From inspection of Figure 3-28A, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - Fa-1 - Fb-1 + R2-1 5. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - Fa0 - Fb0 + R20 6. Integrate this equation from - to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - Fa1 - Fb1 + R21 7. Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 Fa Fb R2 = 0 M = R1 L Fa ( L a ) Fb ( L b ) = 0 R1
1 L
Fa ( L a ) Fb ( L b )
R2 Fa Fb R1 8. Define the range for x
R1 1207 lbf R2 1207 lbf
x 0 m 0.005 L L
9. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 10. Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) Fa S ( x a ) Fb S ( x b ) R2 S ( x L) M ( x) R1 S ( x 0 m) x Fa S ( x a ) ( x a ) Fb S ( x b ) ( x b ) R2 S ( x L) ( x L)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-28-3
11. Plot the shear and moment diagrams. 2000
Shear Diagram
1000 V ( x) 0
lbf
1000 2000
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
x ft
Moment Diagram
10000
15.455
8000
M ( x)
6000
ft lbf 4000 2000 0
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
x ft
FIGURE 3-28B Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-28
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-29-1
PROBLEM 3-29
_____
Statement:
Run the TKSolver or Mathcad model for Case Study 1A and move the point of application of the hand force along the lever by changing the values of Rb2, recalculate and observe the changes to the forces and moments.
Problem:
Determine the forces on the elements of the bicycle brake lever assembly shown in Figure 3-1 during braking.
Given:
The geometry of each element is known. The average human's hand can develop a grip force of about 267 N (60 lb) in the lever position shown. Magnitude of handle force Fb2
Fb2 := 267⋅ N
Direction of handle force Fb2
θb2 := 270⋅ deg
Direction of cable force Fc2
θc2 := 184⋅ deg
Direction of cable force Fcable
θcable := 180⋅ deg
Position vector components (Change the value of Rb2x and note the results) Rb2x := 19⋅ mm
Rc2x := −25⋅ mm
R12x := −12⋅ mm
Rb2y := −4⋅ mm
Rc2y := 0⋅ mm
R12y := −7⋅ mm
R21x := 7⋅ mm
Rb1x := 47.5⋅ mm
R31x := −27⋅ mm
R21y := 19⋅ mm
Rb1y := −14⋅ mm
R31y := 30⋅ mm
Assumptions: The accelerations are negligible. All forces are coplanar and two-dimensional. A class 1 load model is appropriate and a static analysis is acceptable. The higher applied load will be used as a worst case, assuming that it can be reached before bottoming the tip of the handle on the handgrip. If that occurs, it will change the beam's boundary conditions and the analysis. Solution: 1.
See Figures 3-1, 3-2, and Mathcad file P0329.
Figure 3-1 shows the hand brake lever assembly, which consists of three subassemblies: the handlebar (1), the lever (2), and the cable (3). The lever is pivoted to the handlebar and the cable is connected to the lever. The cable runs within a plastic-lined sheath (for low friction) down to the brake caliper assembly at the bicycle's wheel rim. The user's hand applies equal and opposite forces at some point on the lever and handgrip. These forces are transformed to a larger force in the cable by reason of the lever ratio of part 2. Figure 3-1 is a free-body diagram of the entire assembly since it shows all the forces and moments acting on it except for its weight, which is small compared to the applied forces and is thus neglected for this analysis. The "broken away" portion of the handlebar provides internal x and y force components and a moment. These are arbitrarily shown as positive in sign. Their actual signs will "come out in the wash" in the calculations. The known applied forces are shown in their actual directions and senses.
2.
Figure 3-2 shows the three subassembly elements separated and drawn as free-body diagrams with all relevant forces and moments applied to each element, again neglecting the weights of the parts. The lever (part 2) has three forces on it, Fb2, Fc2, and F12. The two-character subscript notation used here should be read as, force of element 1 on 2 (F12) or force at B on 2 (Fb2), etc. This defines the source of the forces (first subscript) and the element on which it acts (second subscript). This notation will be used consistently throughout this text for both forces and position vectors such as Rb2, Rc2, and R12 in Figure 3-2, which serve to locate the above three forces in a local, non rotating coordinate system whose origin is at the center of gravity (CG) of the element or subassembly being analyzed. (See foot note on page 83 of the text). On this brake lever, Fb2 is an applied force whose magnitude and direction are known. Fc2 is the force in the
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-29-2
cable. Its direction is known but not its magnitude. Force F12 is provided by part 1 on part 2 at the pivot pin. Its magnitude and direction are both unknown. We can write equations 3.3b for this element to sum forces in the x and y directions and sum moments about the CG. Note that all unknown reactive forces and moments are initially assumed positive in the equations. Their true signs will come out in the calculation. (See foot note on page 84 of the text).
ΣFx = Fb2x + Fc2x + F12x = 0 (a)
ΣFy = Fb2y + Fc2y + F12y = 0 ΣMz = ( R12 × F12) + ( Rb2 × Fb2) + ( Rc2 × Fc2 ) = 0 The cross products in the moment equation represent the "turning forces" or moments created by the application of these forces at points remote from the CG of the element. Recall that these cross products can be expanded to
ΣMz = ( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) ... = 0
+ ( Rb2x⋅ Fb2y − Rb2y⋅ Fb2x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) c2x c2y c2y c2x
(b)
We have three equations and four unknowns (F12x, F12y, Fc2x, Fc2y) at this point, so we need another equation. It is available from the fact that the direction of Fc2 is known. (The cable can pull only along its axis). We can express one component of the cable force Fc2 in terms of its other component and the known angle θc2 of the cable. (c) Fc2y = Fc2x⋅ tan( θc2 ) We will now use a Mathcad solve block to solve equations a through c. Calculate components of Fb2 Fb2x := Fb2⋅ cos( θb2)
Fb2x = −0 ⋅ N
Fb2y := Fb2⋅ sin( θb2)
Fb2y = −267⋅ N
Guess
F12x := 1000⋅ N
Given
Fb2x + Fc2x + F12x = 0
Fc2x := −1000⋅ N
F12y := 1000⋅ N
Fc2y := −1000⋅ N
Fb2y + Fc2y + F12y = 0
( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) ... = 0 + ( Rb2x⋅ Fb2y − Rb2y⋅ Fb2x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) c2x c2y c2y c2x Fc2y = Fc2x⋅ tan( θc2 )
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-29-3
F12x F 12y := Find ( F , F , F , F ) 12x 12y c2x c2y Fc2x Fc2y Components of the unknown forces F12, and Fc2 F12x = 1047⋅ N 3.
Fc2x = −1047⋅ N
F12y = 340⋅ N
Fc2y = −73.2⋅ N
Part 3 in Figure 3-2 is the cable that passes through a hole in part 1. This hole is lined with a low friction material, which allows us to assume no friction at the joint between parts 1 and 3. We will further assume that the three forces F13, Fc3, and Fcable form a concurrent system of forces acting through the CG and thus create no moment. With this assumption, only a summation of forces is necessary for this element.
ΣFx = Fcablex + F13x + Fc3x = 0 (d)
ΣFy = Fcabley + F13y + Fc3y = 0 Using Newton's third law, we have Fc3x := −Fc2x and Fc3y := −Fc2y. We also assume that the cable entering from the left is horizontal and that the reaction F13 is vertical, thus Fcabley := 0 ⋅ N
and
(e)
F13x := 0 ⋅ N
We can now solve for the forces on part 3 directly, Fcablex := −F13x − Fc3x
Fcablex = −1047⋅ N
F13y := −Fcabley − Fc3y
F13y = −73.2⋅ N
The assembly of elements labeled part 1 in Figure 3-2 has both force and moments on it (i.e., it is not a concurrent system), so the three equations 3.3b are needed.
ΣFx = F21x + Fb1x + F31x + Px + Fsheathx = 0 (f)
ΣFy = F21y + Fb1y + F31y + Py = 0 ΣMz = Mh + ( R21 × F21) + ( Rb1 × Fb1) + ( R31 × F31) ... = 0 + ( Rp × Fp) + ( Rd × Fsheath ) Expanding cross products in the moment equation gives the moment magnitude as
ΣMz = Mh + ( R21x⋅ F21y − R21y⋅ F21x) ... = 0
+ ( Rb1x⋅ Fb1y − Rb1y⋅ Fb1x) ... + ( R31x⋅ F31y − R31y⋅ F31x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) ... Px Py Py Px + ( 0 − Rdy ⋅ Fsheathx)
(g)
Using Newton's third law, we have F31x := −F13x
F21x := −F12x
Fb1x := −Fb2x (h)
F31y := −F13y
F21y := −F12y
Fb1y := −Fb2y
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-29-4
Fsheathx := −Fcablex
Given
RPx := −27⋅ mm
RPy := 0 ⋅ mm
Rdx := −41⋅ mm
Rdy := 27⋅ mm
We will now use a Mathcad solve block to solve equations (f) through (h). Guess
Px := 1000⋅ N
Given
F21x + Fb1x + F31x + Px + Fsheathx = 0
Mh := −100⋅ N ⋅ m
Py := 0 ⋅ N
F21y + Fb1y + F31y + Py = 0
Mh + ( R21x⋅ F21y − R21y⋅ F21x) ... = 0 + ( Rb1x⋅ Fb1y − Rb1y⋅ Fb1x) ... + ( R31x⋅ F31y − R31y⋅ F31x) ... + ( R ⋅ P − R ⋅ P ) ... Px y Py x + ( 0⋅ N ⋅ m − Rdy⋅ Fsheathx)
Px Py := Find( Px , Py , Mh) M h Summarizing, the results obtained for a grip force Fb2 = 267⋅ N are: Handlebar (1)
Fb1x = 0 ⋅ N
Fb1y = 267⋅ N
F21x = −1047⋅ N
F21y = −340⋅ N
F31x = 0 ⋅ N
F31y = 73.2⋅ N −6
Px = 1 × 10
⋅N
Py = 0 ⋅ N
Mh = 0.0⋅ N ⋅ m Lever (2)
Cable (3)
Fc2x = −1047⋅ N
Fc2y = −73.2⋅ N
F12x = 1047⋅ N
F12y = 340⋅ N
Fc3x = 1047⋅ N
Fc3y = 73.2⋅ N
F13x = 0 ⋅ N
F13y = −73.2⋅ N
Fcablex = −1047⋅ N
Fcabley = 0 ⋅ N
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-30-1
PROBLEM 3-30
_____
Statement:
Run the TKSolver or Mathcad model for Case Study 2A and move the point of application of the crimp force along the jaw by changing the values of Rhand, recalculate and observe the changes to the forces and moments.
Problem:
Determine the forces on the elements of the crimping tool shown in Figure 3-3 during a crimp operation.
Given:
The geometry is known and the tool develops a crimp force of 2000 lb (8896 N) at closure in the position shown. Applied crimp force
Fc4x := −1956.30⋅ lbf
Fc4y := 415.82⋅ lbf
Position vector components (Change the value of Rhand and note the results) Rc4x := 0.454⋅ in
R12x := 1.399⋅ in
R32x := 2.199⋅ in
Rc4y := 0.337⋅ in
R12y := 0.049⋅ in
R32y := 0.077⋅ in
R23x := −0.602⋅ in
R43x := 0.602⋅ in
R14x := −0.161⋅ in
R23y := 0.127⋅ in
R43y := −0.127⋅ in
R14y := −0.758⋅ in
R34x := 0.161⋅ in
R34y := 0.758⋅ in
Rhand := −4.40⋅ in
Assumptions: The accelerations are negligible. All forces are coplanar and two-dimensional. A class 1 load model is appropriate and a static analysis is acceptable. Solution: 1.
See Figures 3-3, 3-4, and Mathcad file P0330.
Figure 3-3 shows the tool in the closed position, in the process of crimping a metal connector onto a wire. The user's hand provides the input forces between links 1 and 2, shown as the reaction pair Fhand. The user can grip the handle anywhere along its length but we are assuming a nominal moment arm of Rhand for the application of the resultant of the user's grip force (see Figure 3-4). The high mechanical advantage of the tool transforms the grip force to a large force at the crimp. Figure 3-3 is a free-body diagram of the entire assembly, neglecting the weight of the tool, which is small compared to the crimp force. There are four elements, or links, in the assembly, all pinned together. Link 1 can be considered to be the "ground" link, with the other links moving with respect to it as the jaw is closed. The desired magnitude of the crimp force Fc is defined and its direction will be normal to the surfaces at the crimp.
2.
Figure 3-4 shows the elements of the crimping tool assembly separated and drawn as free-body diagrams with all forces applied to each element, again neglecting their weights as being insignificant compared to the applied forces. The centers of gravity of the respective elements are used as the origins of the local, non rotating coordinate systems in which the points of application of all forces on the element are located. (See footnote on page 116 of the text).
3.
We will consider link 1 to be the ground plane and analyze the remaining moving links. Note that all unknown forces and moments are initially assumed positive. Link 4 has three forces acting on it: Fc4 is the known (desired) force at the crimp, and F14 and F34 are the reaction forces from links 1 and 3, respectively. The magnitudes of these two forces are unknown as is the direction of F14. The direction of F34 will be the same as link 3, since it is a two-force member. Writing equations 3.3b for this element:
ΣFx = F14x + F34x + Fc4x = 0 ΣFy = F14y + F34y + Fc4y = 0
(a)
ΣMz = ( R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) ... = 0
+ ( R34x⋅ F34y − R34y⋅ F34x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) c4x c4y c4y c4x
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-30-2
We have three equations and four unknowns (F14x, F14y, F34x, F34y) at this point, so we need another equation. It is available from the fact that the direction of F34 is known. We can express one component of the force F34 in terms of its other component and the known angle θ3 of link 3. (b) F34y = F34x⋅ tan( θ3) (c)
where
θ3 := 168⋅ deg
Guess
F14x := 500⋅ lbf
Given
F14x + F34x + Fc4x = 0
F34x := 1000⋅ lbf
F14y := −100⋅ lbf
F34y := −100⋅ lbf
F14y + F34y + Fc4y = 0
( Rc4x⋅ Fc4y − Rc4y⋅ Fc4x) ... = 0 + ( R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) 34x 34y 34y 34x F34y = F34x⋅ tan( θ3)
F14x F 14y := Find ( F , F , F , F ) 14x 14y 34x 34y F34x F34y Components of the unknown forces F14, and F34 F14x = 442.9⋅ lbf 4.
5.
F14y = −94.1⋅ lbf
F34x = 1513.4⋅ lbf
F34y = −321.7⋅ lbf
Link 3 has two forces on it, F23 and F43. Because this is a two-force link, these two forces are equal in magnitude and opposite in direction. Also, from Newton's third law, F43 = - F34. Thus, F43x := −F34x
F43y := −F34y
F23x := −F43x
F23y := −F43y
F43x = −1513.4⋅ lbf
F43y = 321.7⋅ lbf
F23x = 1513.4⋅ lbf
F23y = −321.7⋅ lbf
(d)
Link 2 has three forces acting on it: Fhand is the unknown force from the hand, and F12 and F32 are the reaction forces from links 1 and 3, respectively. Force F12 is provided by part 1 on part 2 at the pivot pin and force F32 is provided by part 3 acting on part 2 at their pivot pin. The magnitude and direction of F32 is known and the direction of Fhand is known. Using equations 3.3b, we can solve for the magnitude of Fhand and the two components of F12. From the third law, F32x := −F23x
F32y := −F23y
F32x = −1513.4⋅ lbf
F32y = 321.7⋅ lbf
ΣFx = F12x + F32x = 0 (e)
ΣFy = Fhand + F12y + F32y = 0 ΣMz = ( R12 × F12) + ( R32 × F32) ... = 0 + ( Rhand × Fhand ) Guess
F12x := 1500⋅ lbf
F12y := −100⋅ lbf
Fhand := 100⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Given
3-30-3
F12x + F32x = 0 F12y + F32y + Fhand = 0
( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) ... = 0 + ( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) ... + R ⋅ F hand hand F12x F12y := Find( F12x , F12y , Fhand ) F hand F12x = 1513.4⋅ lbf 6.
7.
F12y = −373.4⋅ lbf
Fhand = 51.7⋅ lbf
The four forces on link 1 can now be determined using the third law. F21x := −F12x
F21y := −F12y
F41x := −F14x
F41y := −F14y
F21x = −1513.4⋅ lbf
F21y = 373.4⋅ lbf
F41x = −442.9⋅ lbf
F41y = 94.1⋅ lbf
Fc1x := −Fc4x
Fc1y := −Fc4y
Fc1x = 1956.3⋅ lbf
Fc1y = −415.8⋅ lbf
The solution to this problem for the scaled dimensions in Figure 3-3 assuming a 2000-lb (8896-N) force applied at the crimp, normal to the crimp surface, is given above. The total forces at the pivot points are: F12 := F12x + F12y
2
0.5
Pivot A
F32 := F32x + F32y
2
0.5
Pivot B
F43 := F43x + F43y
2
0.5
Pivot C
F14 := F14x + F14y
2
0.5
Pivot D
2 2 2 2
F12 = 1559⋅ lbf
F32 = 1547⋅ lbf
F43 = 1547⋅ lbf
F14 = 453⋅ lbf
The moment that must be applied to the handles to generate the crimp force of Crimp force
Fc4 := Fc4x + Fc4y
Moment
Mh := Rhand ⋅ Fhand
2
2
0.5
Fc4 = 2000⋅ lbf Mh = 227⋅ lbf ⋅ in
This moment can be obtained with a force of Fhand = 52⋅ lbf applied at mid-handle. This force is within the physiological grip-force capacity of the average human.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-31-1
PROBLEM 3-31
_____
Statement:
Run the TKSolver or Mathcad model for Case Study 2A and move the point of application of P along the x direction by changing the values of Rpx, recalculate and observe the changes to the forces and moments. What happens when the vertical force P is centered on link 3? Also, change the angle of the applied force P to create an x component and observe the effects on the forces and moments on the elements.
Problem:
Determine the forces on the elements of the scissors-jack in the position shown in Figure 3-5.
Given:
The geometry is known and the jack supports a force of 1000 lb (4448 N) in the position shown. Support force
Px := 0.0⋅ lbf
Py := −1000⋅ lbf
Position vector components (Change the value of Rpx and note the results) Rpx := −0.50⋅ in
R12x := −3.12⋅ in
R32x := 2.08⋅ in
Rpy := 0.87⋅ in
R12y := −1.80⋅ in
R32y := 1.20⋅ in
R42x := 2.71⋅ in
R23x := −0.78⋅ in
R43x := 0.78⋅ in
R42y := 1.00⋅ in
R23y := −0.78⋅ in
R43y := −0.78⋅ in
R14x := 3.12⋅ in
R24x := −2.58⋅ in
R34x := −2.08⋅ in
R14y := −1.80⋅ in
R24y := 1.04⋅ in
R34y := 1.20⋅ in
Angle of gear teeth common normal
θ := −45.0⋅ deg
Assumptions: The accelerations are negligible. The jack is on level ground. The angle of the elevated car chassis does not impart an overturning moment to the jack. All forces are coplanar and two-dimensional. A class 1 load model is appropriate and a static analysis is acceptable. Solution:
See Figures 3-5 through 3-8, and Mathcad file P0331.
1.
Figure 3-5 shows a schematic of a simple scissors jack used to raise a car. It consists of six links that are pivoted and/or geared together and a seventh link in the form of a lead screw that is turned to raise the jack. While this is clearly a three-dimensional device, it can be analyzed as a two-dimensional one if we assume that the applied load (from the car) and the jack are exactly vertical (in the z direction). If so, all forces will be in the xy plane. This assumption is valid if the car is jacked from a level surface. If not, then there will be some forces in the yz and xz planes as well. The jack designer needs to consider the more general case, but for our simple example we will initially assume two-dimensional loading. For the overall assembly as shown in Figure 3-5, we can solve for the reaction force Fg, given force P, by summing forces: Fg = -P.
2.
Figure 3-6 shows a set of free-body diagrams for the entire jack. Each element or subassembly of interest has been separated from the others and the forces and moments shown acting on it (except for its weight, which is small compared to the applied forces and is thus neglected for this analysis). The forces and moments can be either internal reactions at interconnections with other elements or external loads from the "outside world." The centers of gravity of the respective elements are used as the origins of the local, non rotating coordinate systems in which the points of application of all forces on the element are located. In this design, stability is achieved by the mating of two pairs of crude (non involute) gear segments acting between links 2 and 4 and between links 5 and 7. These interactions are modeled as forces acting along a common normal shared by the two teeth. This common normal is perpendicular to the common tangent at the contact point. There are 3 second-law equations available for each of the seven elements allowing 21 unknowns. An additional 10 third-law equations will be needed for a total of 31. This is a cumbersome system to solve for such a simple device, but we can use its symmetry to advantage in order to simplify the problem.
3.
Figure 3-7 shows the upper half of the jack assembly. Because of the mirror symmetry between the upper and lower portions, the lower half can be removed to simplify the analysis. The forces calculated for this half will be duplicated in the other. If we wished, we could solve for the reaction forces at A and B using equations 3.3b from this free-body diagram of the half-jack assembly.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-31-2
4.
Figure 3-8a shows the free-body diagrams for the upper half of the jack assembly, which are essentially the same as those of Figure 3-6. We now have four elements but can consider the subassembly labeled 1 to be the "ground," leaving three elements on which to apply equations 3.3. Note that all forces and moments are initially assumed positive in the equations.
5.
Link 2 has three forces acting on it: F42 is the unknown force at the gear tooth contact with link 4; F12 and F32 are the unknown reaction forces from links 1 and 3, respectively. Force F12 is provided by part 1 on part 2 at the pivot pin and force F32 is provided by part 3 acting on part 2 at their pivot pin. The magnitudes and the directions of these pin forces and the magnitude of F42 are unknown. The direction of F42 is along the common normal shown in Figure 3-8b. Write equations 3.3b for this element to sum the forces in the x and y directions and sum moments about the CG (with the cross products expanded). ΣFx = F12x + F32x + F42x = 0 (a)
ΣFy = F12y + F32y + F42y = 0 ΣMz = ( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) ... = 0
+ ( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) 42x 42y 42y 42x
6.
Link 3 has three forces acting on it: P, F23 and F43. Only P is known. Writing equations 3.3b for this element gives
ΣFx = F23x + F43x + Px = 0 (b)
ΣFy = F23y + F43y + Py = 0 ΣMz = ( R23x⋅ F23y − R23y⋅ F23x) ... = 0
+ ( R43x⋅ F43y − R43y⋅ F43x) ... + ( R ⋅ P − R ⋅ P ) px y py x
7.
Link 4 has three forces acting on it: F24 is the unknown force from link 2; F14 and F34 are the unknown reaction forces from links 1 and 3, respectively.
ΣFx = F14x + F24x + F34x = 0 (c)
ΣFy = F14y + F24y + F34y = 0 ΣMz = ( R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) ... = 0
+ ( R24x⋅ F24y − R24y⋅ F24x) ... + ( R ⋅ F − R ⋅ F ) 34x 34y 34y 34x
8.
9.
The nine equations in sets a through c have 16 unknowns in them, F12x, F12y, F32x, F32y, F23x, F23y, F43x, F43y, F14x , F14y, F34x, F34y, F24x, F24y, F42x, F42y. We can write the third-law relationships between action-reaction pairs at each of the joints to obtain six of the seven additional equations needed: F32x = −F23x
F32y = −F23y
F34x = −F43x
F34y = −F43y
F42x = −F24x
F42y = −F24y
(d)
The last equation needed comes from the relationship between the x and y components of the force F24 (or F42) at the tooth/tooth contact point. Such a contact (or half) joint can transmit force (excepting friction force) only along the common normal , which is perpendicular to the joint's common tangent as shown in Figure 3-8b. The common normal is also called the axis of transmission.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-31-3
The tangent of the angle of this common normal relates the two components of the force at the joint: (e)
F24y = F24x⋅ tan( θ ) 10. Equations (d) and (e) will be substituted into equations (a) through (c) to create a set of nine simultaneous equations for solution. Guess
Given
F12x := 500⋅ lbf
F12y := 500⋅ lbf
F14x := −500⋅ lbf
F23x := 500⋅ lbf
F23y := 500⋅ lbf
F24x := 500⋅ lbf
F43x := −500⋅ lbf
F43y := 500⋅ lbf
( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) ... + ( −R32x⋅ F23y + R32y⋅ F23x) ... + ( −R ⋅ F ⋅ tan( θ ) + R ⋅ F ) 42x 24x 42y 24x
=0
F14y := 500⋅ lbf
F12x − F23x − F24x = 0 F12y − F23y − F24x⋅ tan( θ ) = 0
( R23x⋅ F23y − R23y⋅ F23x) ... = 0 + ( R43x⋅ F43y − R43y⋅ F43x) ... + ( R ⋅ P − R ⋅ P ) px y py x
F23x + F43x + Px = 0
( R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) ... =0 + ( R24x⋅ F24x⋅ tan( θ ) − R24y⋅ F24x) ... + ( −R ⋅ F + R ⋅ F ) 34x 43y 34y 43x
F14x + F24x − F43x = 0
F23y + F43y + Py = 0
F14y + F24x⋅ tan( θ ) − F43y = 0
F12x F12y F14x F14y F23x := Find ( F , F , F , F , F , F , F , F , F ) 12x 12y 14x 14y 23x 23y 24x 43x 43y F23y F 24x F43x F43y Results:
F14x = −877.8⋅ lbf
F14y = 469.6⋅ lbf
F24x = 290.1⋅ lbf
F24y := F24x⋅ tan( θ )
F34x := −F43x
F34y := −F43y
F23x = 587.7⋅ lbf
F23y = 820.5⋅ lbf
F43x = −587.7⋅ lbf
F43y = 179.5⋅ lbf
F12x = 877.8⋅ lbf
F12y = 530.4⋅ lbf
F32x := −F23x
F32y := −F23y
F42x := −F24x
F42y := −F24y
F24y = −290.1⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-32-1
PROBLEM 3-32
_____
Statement:
Figure P3-14 shows a cam-follower arm. If the load P = 200 lb, what spring force is needed at the right end to maintain a minimum load between cam and follower of 25 lb? Find the maximum shear force and bending moment in the follower arm. Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
Given:
Load at left end of beam Load at cam follower
P := 200⋅ lbf Pcam := 25⋅ lbf
Distance from left end to: Pivot point Cam follower Spring Solution: 1.
a := 10⋅ in b := 22⋅ in c := 29⋅ in
See Figure P3-14 and Mathcad file P0332.
Draw a FBD of the cam-follower arm (beam). c b
P
C
R
2.
Pcam
Fspring
From inspection of the FBD, write the load function equation q(x) = -P-1 + R-1 + Pcam-1 - Fspring-1
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = -P0 + R0 + Pcam0 - Fspring0
4.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = -P1 + R1 + Pcam1 - Fspring1
5.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = c, where both are zero. At x = c+, V = M = 0
V = −P + R + Pcam − Fspring = 0 M = −P⋅ c + R⋅ ( c − a ) + Pcam⋅ ( c − b ) = 0
Fspring :=
P⋅ a + Pcam⋅ ( b − a ) c−a
R := Fspring + P − Pcam 6.
Define the range for x
x := 0 ⋅ in , 0.002⋅ c .. c
Fspring = 121.05⋅ lbf R = 296.05⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 7.
3-32-2
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 )
8.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := −P⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) + R⋅ S ( x , a ) + Pcam⋅ S ( x , b ) − Fspring⋅ S ( x , c) M ( x) := −P⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) ⋅ x + R⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a) + Pcam⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b ) − Fspring⋅ S ( x , c) ⋅ ( x − c)
9.
Plot the shear and moment diagrams and find the maximum shear force and bending moment.
SHEAR DIAGRAM 200 100
V ( x) lbf
0 − 100 − 200 − 300
0
10
20
30
x in
Vmax := V ( 0 ⋅ in)
Vmax = 200⋅ lbf
MOMENT DIAGRAM 0
− 500 M ( x) in⋅ lbf
− 1000
− 1500
− 2000
0
10
20
30
x in
Mmax := M ( a )
Mmax = 2000⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
PROBLEM 3-33
3-33-1
_____
Statement:
Write a computer program or equation solver model to calculate all the singularity functions listed in equations 3.17. Set them up as functions that can be called from within any other program or model.
Solution:
See Mathcad file P0333.
1.
No solution is provided for this programming problem.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-34a-1
PROBLEM 3-34a Statement:
Given:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-15. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-2. Beam length
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to concentrated load
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load
P := 1000⋅ lbf
b
P
R2
R1 a
FIGURE 3-34aA Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-34 and Mathcad file P0334a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-34
From inspection of Figure 3-34, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 + R2-1 - P-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 + R20 - P0
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 + R21 - P1
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = b, where both are zero. At x = b +, V = M = 0 V = R1 + R2 − P = 0 M = R1 ⋅ b + R2 ⋅ ( b − a ) = 0 R1 :=
P a
⋅ (a − b)
R2 := P − R1
R1 = −125⋅ lbf R2 = 1125⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) − P⋅ S ( x , b ) M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) ⋅ x + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a ) − P⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b)
8.
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-34a-2
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
1000
0 500 V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf
− 1000
0 − 2000
− 500
0
5
10
15
− 3000
20
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-34aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-34a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( a )
Vmax = 1000⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = a: Mmax := M ( a )
Mmax = 2000⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-35a-1
PROBLEM 3-35a Statement:
Input data:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-15. Write a computer program or equation solver model to find the reactions and calculate and plot the loading, shear, and moment functions. Test the program with the data given in row a from Table P3-2. b
Enter data in highlighted areas Beam length
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to concentrated load
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load
F := 1000⋅ lbf
F
R2
R1 a
FIGURE 3-34aA Solution: 1.
See Figures 3-35 and Mathcad file P0335a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-34
From inspection of Figure 3-35, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 + R2-1 - F-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 + R20 - F0
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 + R21 - F1
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = b, where both are zero. At x = b +, V = M = 0 V = R1 + R2 − F = 0 M = R1 ⋅ b + R2 ⋅ ( b − a ) = 0 R1 :=
F a
⋅ ( a − b)
R2 := F − R1
R1 = −125⋅ lbf R2 = 1125⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) − F ⋅ S ( x , b ) M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) ⋅ x + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a ) − F ⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b )
8.
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-35a-2
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
1000
0 500 V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf
− 1000
0 − 2000
− 500
0
5
10
15
− 3000
20
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-34aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-35a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( a )
Vmax = 1000⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = a: Mmax := M ( a )
Mmax = 2000⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-36a-1
PROBLEM 3-36a Statement: Given:
Solution: 1.
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-16. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-2. Beam length
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to start of load
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to end of load
b := 18⋅ in
Distributed load
p := 1000⋅
b a
L
R1
lbf in
p
R2
FIGURE 3-36aA
See Figures 3-36 and Mathcad file P0336a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-36
From inspection of Figure 3-36, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - p0 + p0 + R2-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - p1 + p1 + R20
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - p2/2 + p2/2 + R21
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 − p ⋅ ( L − a ) + p ⋅ ( L − b ) + R2 = 0 M = R1 ⋅ L −
R1 :=
p 2⋅ L
p 2
2
⋅ (L − a) +
p 2
2
⋅ ( L − b ) + R2⋅ ( L − b) = 0
⋅ 2 ⋅ ( b − a ) ⋅ L + a − b 2
2
R1 = 300⋅ lbf
R2 := p ⋅ ( b − a ) − R1
R2 = 1700⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ in , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) − p ⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a) + p ⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b ) + R2⋅ S ( x , L) M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) ⋅ x −
p 2
2
⋅ S(x , a)⋅ ( x − a) +
p 2
2
⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b ) + R2⋅ S ( x , L) ⋅ ( x − L)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 8.
3-36a-2
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
5000
4000 0 V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf
3000
2000 − 1000 1000
− 2000
0
5
10
15
20
0
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-36aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-36a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( b )
Vmax = 1700⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = c, where:
c :=
R1 ⋅ b + R2 ⋅ a R1 + R2
Mmax := M ( c)
c = 16.3⋅ in
Mmax = 4845⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-37a-1
PROBLEM 3-37a Statement:
Input data:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-16. Write a computer program or equation solver model to find the reactions and calculate and plot the loading, shear, and moment functions. Test the program with the data given in row a from Table P3-2. Enter data in highlighted areas Beam length
Solution: 1.
b
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to start of load
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to end of load
b := 18⋅ in
Distributed load
p := 1000⋅
a
p
L
R1
R2
lbf
FIGURE 3-37aA
in
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-37
See Figures 3-37 and Mathcad file P0337a.
From inspection of Figure 3-37, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - p0 + p0 + R2-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - p1 + p1 + R20
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - p2/2 + p2/2 + R21
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 − p ⋅ ( L − a ) + p ⋅ ( L − b ) + R2 = 0 M = R1 ⋅ L −
R1 :=
p 2⋅ L
p 2
2
⋅ (L − a) +
p 2
2
⋅ ( L − b ) + R2⋅ ( L − b) = 0
⋅ 2 ⋅ ( b − a ) ⋅ L + a − b 2
2
R1 = 300⋅ lbf
R2 := p ⋅ ( b − a ) − R1
R2 = 1700⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ in , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) − p ⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a) + p ⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b ) + R2⋅ S ( x , L) M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) ⋅ x −
p 2
2
⋅ S(x , a)⋅ ( x − a) +
p 2
2
⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b ) + R2⋅ S ( x , L) ⋅ ( x − L)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 8.
3-37a-2
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
5000
4000 0 V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf
3000
2000 − 1000 1000
− 2000
0
5
10
15
20
0
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-37aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-37a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( b )
Vmax = 1700⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = c, where:
c :=
R1 ⋅ b + R2 ⋅ a R1 + R2
Mmax := M ( c)
c = 16.3⋅ in
Mmax = 4845⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-38a-1
PROBLEM 3-38a Statement:
Given:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-17. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-2. Beam length
b
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to concentrated load
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load
P := 1000⋅ lbf
Distributed load
p := 1000⋅ lbf ⋅ in
P
p
R2
R1 a
−1
FIGURE 3-38aA Solution: 1.
2.
See Figure 3-38 and Mathcad file P0338a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-38
Determine the distance from the origin to the left and right ends of the roller. Distance to left end
e := 0.1⋅ a
e = 1.600⋅ in
Distance to right end
f := 0.9⋅ a
f = 14.400in ⋅
From inspection of Figure 3-38, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - p0 + p0 + R2-1 - P-1
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - p1 + p1 + R20 - P0
4.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - p2/2 + p2/2 + R21 - P1
5.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = b, where both are zero. At x = b +, V = M = 0 V = R1 − p ⋅ ( b − e ) + p ⋅ ( b − f ) + R2 − P = 0 M = R1 ⋅ b −
R1 :=
p 2
2
⋅ ( b − e) +
p 2
2
⋅ ( b − f ) + R2⋅ ( b − a) = 0
e2 − f 2 b − a + f − e ⋅ p − ⋅P 2⋅ a a
R2 := p ⋅ ( f − e) − R1 + P
R1 = 6275⋅ lbf R2 = 7525⋅ lbf
6.
Define the range for x
7.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 8.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ m) − p ⋅ S ( x , e) ⋅ ( x − e) + p ⋅ S ( x , f ) ⋅ ( x − f ) + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) − P⋅ S ( x , b ) p 2 2 ⋅ S ( x , e) ⋅ ( x − e) + ⋅ S ( x , f ) ⋅ ( x − f ) ... 2 2 + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a) − P⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b )
M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ m) ⋅ x −
p
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
9.
3-38a-2
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
10000
30000
5000
20000
V ( x) lbf
M ( x) 0
in⋅ lbf
10000
− 5000
− 10000
0
0
5
10
15
− 10000
20
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-38aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-38a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( f )
Vmax = 6525⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = c: c−e R1
=
f −c R2 − P
Mmax := M ( c)
c :=
f ⋅ R1 + e ⋅ R2 − e ⋅ P R1 + R2 − P
c = 7.875⋅ in
Mmax = 29728⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-39a-1
PROBLEM 3-39a Statement:
Input data:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-17. Write a computer program or equation solver model to find the reactions and calculate and plot the loading, shear, and moment functions. Test the program with the data given in row a from Table P3-2. Enter data in highlighted areas Beam length
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to concentrated load
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load
P := 1000⋅ lbf
Distributed load Solution: 1.
2.
b
p := 1000⋅ lbf ⋅ in
P
p
R2
R1 a
−1
FIGURE 3-39aA Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-39
See Figure 3-39 and Mathcad file P0339a.
Determine the distance from the origin to the left and right ends of the roller. Distance to left end
e := 0.1⋅ a
e = 40.64⋅ mm
Distance to right end
f := 0.9⋅ a
f = 365.76mm ⋅
From inspection of Figure 3-39, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - p0 + p0 + R2-1 - P-1
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - p1 + p1 + R20 - P0
4.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - p2/2 + p2/2 + R21 - P1
5.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = b, where both are zero. At x = b +, V = M = 0 V = R1 − p ⋅ ( b − e ) + p ⋅ ( b − f ) + R2 − P = 0 M = R1 ⋅ b −
R1 :=
p 2
2
⋅ ( b − e) +
p 2
2
⋅ ( b − f ) + R2⋅ ( b − a) = 0
e2 − f 2 b − a + f − e ⋅ p − ⋅P 2 ⋅ a a
R2 := p ⋅ ( f − e) − R1 + P
R1 = 6275⋅ lbf R2 = 7525⋅ lbf
6.
Define the range for x
7.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 8.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ m) − p ⋅ S ( x , e) ⋅ ( x − e) + p ⋅ S ( x , f ) ⋅ ( x − f ) + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) − P⋅ S ( x , b )
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-39a-2
p 2 2 ⋅ S ( x , e) ⋅ ( x − e) + ⋅ S ( x , f ) ⋅ ( x − f ) ... 2 2 + R2⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a) − P⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b )
M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ m) ⋅ x −
9.
p
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
10000
30000
5000
20000
V ( x) lbf
M ( x) 0
in⋅ lbf
10000
− 5000
− 10000
0
0
5
10
15
− 10000
20
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-39aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-39a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( f )
Vmax = 6525⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = c: c−e R1
=
f −c R2 − P
Mmax := M ( c)
c :=
f ⋅ R1 + e ⋅ R2 − e ⋅ P R1 + R2 − P
c = 7.875⋅ in
Mmax = 29728⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-40a-1
PROBLEM 3-40a Statement:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-18. Find the reactions, maximum shear, and maximum moment for the data given in row a from Table P3-2. a
Given:
Distance to gear 2
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to gear 1
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load at gear 2
P2 := 1000⋅ lbf
Concentrated load at gear 1
P1 := 0.4⋅ P2
P1
P2
R2
R1 b L
FIGURE 3-40a Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-40 and Mathcad file P0340a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-40
From inspection of Figure 3-40, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - P1-1 + R2-1 - P2-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - P10 + R20 - P20
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - P11 + R21 - P1
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 − P1 + R2 − P2 = 0 M = R1⋅ L − P1⋅ ( L − a ) + R2⋅ ( b − a ) = 0 R1 := P1⋅ 1 −
+ P2⋅ 1 − b a
L
b
R2 := P1 + P2 − R1
R1 = −67⋅ lbf R2 = 1467⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ in) − P1⋅ S ( x , a ) + R2⋅ S ( x , b ) − P2⋅ S ( x , L) M ( x) := R1⋅ S ( x , 0 ⋅ mm) ⋅ ( x − 0 ⋅ mm) − P1⋅ S ( x , a ) ⋅ ( x − a ) ... + R2⋅ S ( x , b ) ⋅ ( x − b) − P2⋅ S ( x , L) ⋅ ( x − L)
8.
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-40a-2
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
0
500
− 1000
V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf 0
− 500
− 2000
0
5
10
15
20
− 3000
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-40aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-40a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( b )
Vmax = 1000⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = b: Mmax := M ( b )
Mmax = 2000⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-41a-1
PROBLEM 3-41a Statement:
Input data:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P3-18. Write a computer program or equation solver model to find the reactions and calculate and plot the loading, shear, and moment functions. Test the program with the data given in row a from Table P3-2. a
Enter data in highlighted areas Distance to gear 2
L := 20⋅ in
Distance to gear 1
a := 16⋅ in
Distance to RH bearing
b := 18⋅ in
Concentrated load at gear 2
P2 := 1000⋅ lbf
Concentrated load at gear 1
P1 := 0.4⋅ P2
P1
P2
R2
R1 b L
FIGURE 3-41aA Solution: 1.
See Figure 3-41 and Mathcad file P0341a.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 3-41
From inspection of Figure 3-41, write the load function equation q(x) = R1-1 - P1-1 + R2-1 - P2-1
2.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain shear, V(x) V(x) = R10 - P10 + R20 - P20
3.
Integrate this equation from -∞ to x to obtain moment, M(x) M(x) = R11 - P11 + R21 - P1
4.
Solve for the reactions by evaluating the shear and moment equations at a point just to the right of x = L, where both are zero. At x = L+, V = M = 0 V = R1 − P1 + R2 − P2 = 0 M = R1⋅ L − P1⋅ ( L − a ) + R2⋅ ( b − a ) = 0 R1 := P1⋅ 1 −
+ P2⋅ 1 − b a
L
b
R2 := P1 + P2 − R1
R1 = −67⋅ lbf R2 = 1467⋅ lbf
5.
Define the range for x
6.
For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z.
x := 0 ⋅ m , 0.002⋅ L .. L
S ( x , z) := if ( x ≥ z , 1 , 0 ) 7.
Write the shear and moment equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. V ( z) := R1⋅ S ( z , 0 ⋅ in) − P1⋅ S ( z , a) + R2⋅ S ( z , b) − P2⋅ S ( z , L) M ( z) := R1⋅ S ( z , 0 ⋅ mm) ⋅ ( z − 0 ⋅ mm ) − P1⋅ S ( z , a) ⋅ ( z − a ) ... + R2⋅ S ( z , b) ⋅ ( z − b ) − P2⋅ S ( z , L) ⋅ ( z − L)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 8.
3-41a-2
Plot the shear and moment diagrams.
SHEAR DIAGRAM
MOMENT DIAGRAM
1000
0
500
− 1000
V ( x)
M ( x)
lbf
in⋅ lbf 0
− 500
− 2000
0
5
10
15
20
− 3000
0
5
10
x
x
in
in
15
20
FIGURE 3-41aB Shear and Moment Diagrams for Problem 3-41a
9.
Determine the maximum shear and maximum moment from inspection of the diagrams. Maximum shear:
Vmax := V ( b )
Vmax = 1000⋅ lbf
Maximum moment occurs where V is zero, which is x = b: Mmax := M ( b )
Mmax = 2000⋅ in⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
PROBLEM 3-42
3-42-1
_____
Statement:
A 1000 kg speedboat reaches a speed of 16 kph at the instant it takes up the slack in a 100 m-long tow rope attached to a surfboard carrying a 100 kg passenger. If the rope has k = 5 N/m, what is the dynamic force exerted on the surfboard?
Given:
Mass of speedboat
ms := 1000⋅ kg
Speed of boat
vi := 16⋅ kph
Mass of passenger
mp := 100⋅ kg
Rope stiffness
k := 5 ⋅ N ⋅ m
−1
Assumptions: 1. The water does not influence the dynamic force. 2. An impact model can be used to estimate the dynamic force. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0342.
For the impact model, the passenger is the "struck" mass and the speedboat is the "striking mass". Thus, from equation 3.15, the energy correction factor is: 1
η := 1+
2.
mp
η = 0.97
3 ⋅ ms
Use equation 3.11 to estimate the dynamic force on the surfboard/passenger.
Fi := vi⋅ η⋅ ms⋅ k
Fi = 309⋅ N
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-43-1
PROBLEM 3-43 Statement:
Figure P3-19 shows an oil-field pump jack. For the position shown, draw free-body diagrams of the crank (2), connecting rod (3) and walking beam (4) using variable names similar to those used in Case Studies 1A and 2A. Assume that the crank turns slowly enough that accelerations can be ignored. Include the weight acting at the CG of the walking beam and the crank but not the connecting rod.
Assumptions: 1. A two-dimensional model is adequate. 2. Inertia forces may be ignored. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0343.
Isolate each of the elements to be analyzed, starting with the walking beam, since the external forces on it are known. Place the known force, Fcable, at the point P and the known weight at the CG. Assume the forces at the interfaces O4 and B to be positive. The position vectors R14, R34, and Rp will be known as will the angle, θ3,that the connecting rod makes with the horizontal axis.
F34 R34 y
R 14 RP
head end P
F
B x
14y
4
counterweight
O4
F cable 2.
θ3
F
14x
W4
F43
The connecting rod is a two-force member with the forces acting at the interfaces A and B along the line joining points A and B. The assumption made in step 1 is that these are compressive forces on link 3.
y B R 43
3
θ3 x
R23
A
F 23
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0343.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 3.
3-43-2
The crank is acted on by forces at A and O2, its weight at its CG, and a torque which we will assume to be positive (CCW). As in step 1, assume that the unknown reaction force at O2 is positive.
F32 y
F
A
12y
θ3 x
2 O2
F
12x
T2 W2
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0343.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-44-1
PROBLEM 3-44 Statement:
For the pump jack of Problem 3-43 and the data of Table P3-3, determine the pin forces on the walking beam, connecting rod, and crank and the reaction torque on the crank.
Given:
R12 := 13.2⋅ in
θ12 := 135⋅ deg
R14 := 79.22⋅ in
θ14 := 196⋅ deg
R32 := 0.80⋅ in
θ32 := 45⋅ deg
R34 := 32.00⋅ in
θ34 := 169⋅ deg
Fcable := 2970⋅ lbf
W2 := 598⋅ lbf
θ3 := 98.5⋅ deg Solution: 1.
W4 := 2706⋅ lbf
RP := 124.44⋅ in θP := 185⋅ deg
See Mathcad files P0343 and P0344.
Draw free-body diagrams of each element (see Problem 3-43).
F34 R34 y
R 14
θ3
RP
head end
F
P
B x
14y
4
counterweight
O4
F
14x
W4
F cable
F43 y B
F32 y
F
R 43
A
12y
3
θ3
θ3 x
x 2 O2
F
12x
R23
T2 W2 A
F 23 © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0344.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 2. Calculate the x- and y-components of the position vectors.
3.
4.
3-44-2
R12x := R12⋅ cos( θ12)
R12x = −9.334⋅ in
R12y := R12⋅ sin( θ12)
R12y = 9.334⋅ in
R14x := R14⋅ cos( θ14)
R14x = −76.151⋅ in
R14y := R14⋅ sin( θ14)
R14y = −21.836⋅ in
R32x := R32⋅ cos( θ32)
R32x = 0.566⋅ in
R32y := R32⋅ sin( θ32)
R32y = 0.566⋅ in
R34x := R34⋅ cos( θ34)
R34x = −31.412⋅ in
R34y := R34⋅ sin( θ34)
R34y = 6.106⋅ in
RPx := RP⋅ cos( θP)
RPx = −123.966 ⋅ in
RPy := RP⋅ sin( θP)
RPy = −10.846⋅ in
Write equations 3(b) for link 4, the walking beam.
Σ Fx:
F14x + F34x = 0
(1)
Σ Fy:
−Fcable + F14y + F34y − W4 = 0
(2)
Σ Mz:
Rpx⋅ Fcable + ( R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) + ( R34x⋅ F34y − R34y⋅ F34x) = 0
(3)
The direction (but not the sense) of F34 is known so write the equation that relates the x- and y-components of this force. F34y − F34x⋅ tan( θ3) = 0
5.
(4)
There are four unknowns in the four equations above. Solving for F14x, F14y, F34x, and F34y, 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 A := −R14y R14x −R34y R34x in in in in 0 −tan( θ3) 1 0 F14x = 2446⋅ lbf
6.
7.
8.
F14y = −10687⋅ lbf
0 F + W 4 cable lbf B := −RPx ⋅ Fcable in⋅ lbf 0 F34x = −2446⋅ lbf
F14x F 14y := A − 1⋅ B⋅ lbf F34x F34y F34y = 16363⋅ lbf
From Newton's thrid law and, since the connecting rod (3) is a two-force member F43x := −F34x
F43x = 2446⋅ lbf
F43y := −F34y
F43y = −16363⋅ lbf
F23x := −F43x
F23x = −2446⋅ lbf
F23y := −F43y
F23y = 16363⋅ lbf
Write equations 3(b) for link 2, the crank.
Σ Fx:
F12x + F32x = 0
(5)
Σ Fy:
F12y + F32y − W2 = 0
(6)
Σ Mz:
T2 + ( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) + ( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) = 0
(7)
There are three unknowns in the three equations above. Solving for F12x, F12y, and T2, since F32x := −F23x
F32x = 2446⋅ lbf
F32y := −F23y
F32y = −16363⋅ lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0344.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-44-3
−F32x lbf W2 − F32y B := lbf −( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) in⋅ lbf
0 0 1 0 1 0 A := −R12y R12x 1 in in
F12x = −2446
lbf
T2 = 146128
in-lbf
F12y = 16961
F12x −1 F12y := A ⋅ B T 2
lbf
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0344.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-45-1
PROBLEM 3-45 Statement:
Figure P3-20 shows an aircraft overhead bin mechanism in end view. For the position shown, draw free-body diagrams of links 2 and 4 and the door (3) using variable names similar to those used in Case Studies 1A and 2A. There are stops that prevent further clockwise motion of link 2 (and the identical link behind it at the other end of the door) resulting in horizontal forces being applied to the door at points A. Assume that the mechanism is symmetrical so that each set of links 2 and 4 carry one half of the door weight. Ignore the weight of links 2 and 4 as they are negligible.
Assumptions: 1. A two-dimensional model is adequate. 2. Inertia forces may be ignored as the mechanism is at rest against stops. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0345.
Isolate each of the elements to be analyzed, starting with the door. Place the force, Fstop, at the point A and the known weight at the CG. Assume the forces in links 2 and 4 to be positive (tensile). The position vectors R43 and R23 will be known as will the angles θ2 and θ4 that links 2 and 4 make with the horizontal axis.
F 23 θ4 F 43
θ2
y
F stop
R43
R23
A
3
B x
W3 2
2.
F 12
Links 2 and 4 are two-force members with the forces acting at the pinned ends along the line joining the pin centers. The assumption made in step 1 is that these are tensile forces on links 2 and 4.
θ2
y O2 R12 2
x θ4
y
R32
F 14
A O4
R14
x 4
R34
B
F 34
F 32
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0345.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-46-1
PROBLEM 3-46 Statement:
For the overhead bin mechanism of Problem 3-45 and the data of Table P3-4, determine the pin forces on the door (3), and links 2 & 4 and the reaction force on each of the two stops.
Given:
R23 := 180.0⋅ mm θ23 := 160.345⋅ deg W3 := 45⋅ N
Solution: 1.
θ43 := 27.862⋅ deg
R43 := 180.0⋅ mm
θ2 := 85.879⋅ deg
θ4 := 172.352 ⋅ deg
See Mathcad files P0345 and P0346.
Draw free-body diagrams of each element (see Problem 3-45).
F 12
θ2
y O2
θ4
y
F 14
R12 2
O4
x
x
R14
4
R34
F 34
B
R32 A F 23 θ4 F 43
θ2
F 32
y
F stop
A
R23
R43 3
B x
W3 2 2.
3.
Calculate the x- and y-components of the position vectors on the door (3). R23x := R23⋅ cos( θ23)
R23x = −169.512 ⋅ mm
R23y := R23⋅ sin( θ23)
R23y = 60.544⋅ mm
R43x := R43⋅ cos( θ43)
R43x = 159.134 ⋅ mm
R43y := R43⋅ sin( θ43)
R43y = 84.122⋅ mm
Write equations 3(b) for link 3, the door.
Σ Fx:
Fstop + F23x + F43x = 0
(1)
Σ © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0346.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. F23y + F43y − 0.5⋅ W3 = 0 Σ Fy:
Σ Mz: 4.
5.
3-46-2 (2)
−R23x⋅ Fstop + ( R23x⋅ F23y − R23y⋅ F23x) + ( R43x⋅ F43y − R43y⋅ F43x) = 0
(3)
The directions (but not the sense) of F 23 and F43 are known so write the equations that relates the x- and y-components of these forces. F23y − F23x⋅ tan( θ2) = 0
(4)
F43y − F43x⋅ tan( θ4) = 0
(5)
There are five unknowns in the five equations above. Solving for F23x, F23y, F43x, F43y, and Fstop:
0 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 −R23y R23x −R43y R43x −R23x A := mm mm mm mm mm 0 0 0 −tan( θ2) 1 0 0 −tan( θ4) 1 0
F23x = 1.49⋅ N
F23y = 20.63⋅ N
0 0.5⋅ W3 N B := 0 0 0
F43x = −13.96⋅ N
F23x F23y F43x := A − 1⋅ B⋅ N F43y F stop
F43y = 1.87⋅ N
The pin forces at A and B are: F23 :=
2
F23x + F23y
The force on each stop is: 6.
2
F23 = 20.68⋅ N
F43 :=
2
F43x + F43y
2
F43 = 14.08⋅ N
Fstop = 12.47⋅ N
From Newton's thrid law and, since links 2 and 4 are two-force members F34x := −F43x
F34x = 13.96⋅ N
F34y := −F43y
F34y = −1.87⋅ N
F32x := −F23x
F32x = −1.49⋅ N
F32y := −F23y
F32y = −20.63⋅ N
The pin forces at O2 and O4 are numerically equal to those at A and B, respectively.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0346.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-47-1
PROBLEM 3-47 Statement:
A particular automobile front suspension consists of two A-arms , the wheel (with tire), a coil spring, and a shock absorber (damper). The effective stiffness of the suspension (called the "ride rate") is a function of the coil spring stiffness and the tire stiffness. The A-arms are designed to give the wheel a nearly vertical displacement as the tire rides over bumps in the road. The entire assembly can be modeled as a spring-mass-damper system as shown in Figure 3-15(b). If the sprung mass (mass of the portion of the vehicle supported by the suspension system) weighs 675 lb, determine the ride rate that is required to achieve an undamped natural frequency of 1.4 Hz. What is the static deflection of the suspension for the calculated ride rate?
Units:
Hz := 2 ⋅ π⋅ rad⋅ sec
Given:
Sprung mass
Solution:
See Figure 3-15(b) and Mathcad file P0347.
−1
Ws := 675⋅ lbf
Ws
Natural frequency ωn := 1.4⋅ Hz
2
1.
Calculate the sprung mass Ms :=
2.
Using equation 3.4, calculate the required ride rate Ride rate
3.
−1
Ms = 1.748 lbf ⋅ sec ⋅ in
g
2
k := ωn ⋅ Ms
k = 135.28
lbf in
Calculate the static deflection using equation 3.5 Static deflection
δ :=
Ws k
δ = 4.99in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0347.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-48-1
PROBLEM 3-48 Statement:
The independent suspension system of Problem 3-47 has an unsprung weight (the weight of the axle, wheel, A-arms, etc.) of 106 lb. Calculate the natural frequency (hop resonance) of the unsprung mass if the sum of the tire and coil spring stiffnesses is 1100 lb/in.
Units:
Hz := 2 ⋅ π⋅ rad⋅ sec
Given:
Unsprung mass
Solution:
−1
Wu := 106⋅ lbf
Stiffness
k := 1100⋅
lbf in
See Figure 3-15(b) and Mathcad file P0348. Wu
2
1.
Calculate the unsprung mass Mu :=
2.
Using equation 3.4, calculate the natural frequency Natural frequency
−1
Mu = 0.275 lbf ⋅ sec ⋅ in
g
ωn :=
k Mu
ωn = 10.1 Hz
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0348.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-49-1
PROBLEM 3-49 Statement:
The independent suspension system of Problem 3-47 has a sprung weight of 675 lb and a ride rate of 135 lb/in. Calculate the damped natural frequency of the sprung mass if the damping coefficient of the shock absorber is a constant 12 lb-sec/in.
Units:
Hz := 2 ⋅ π⋅ rad⋅ sec
Given:
Sprung mass
−1
Ws := 675⋅ lbf
Damping coefficient
Solution:
d := 12⋅
Ride rate
k := 135⋅
lbf in
lbf ⋅ sec in
See Figure 3-15(b) and Mathcad file P0349. Ws
2
1.
Calculate the sprung mass Ms :=
2.
Using equation 3.7, calculate the damped natural frequency
g
Ms = 1.748lbf ⋅ sec ⋅ in
Damped natural frequency
ωd :=
k Ms
−1
−
2⋅ Ms d
2
ωd = 1.29Hz
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0349.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-50-1
PROBLEM 3-50_______________________________________________________ Statement:
Figure P3-22 shows a powder compaction mechanism. For the position shown, draw free-body diagrams of the input arm (2), connecting rod (3) and compacting ram (4) using variable names similar to those used in Case Studies 1A and 2A. Assume that the input arm turns slowly enough that accelerations can be ignored. Ignore the weights of the arm, connecting rod, and compacting ram. Neglect friction.
Assumptions: 1. A two-dimensional model is adequate. 2. Inertia forces may be ignored. 3. The reactions at slider bearings E and F can be modeled as concentrated forces acting horizontally at the center of each bearing. See Mathcad file P0350.
Solution: 1.
y
Isolate each of the elements to be analyzed, starting with the compacting rod, since the external force on it is known. Place the known force, Fcom , at the point P. The position vectors R14E,
F14E
R14F, and R p will be known as will the angle, q3,that the compacting ram makes with the vertical axis. 2.
3.
R14E
E
R34
D
The connecting rod is a two-force member with the forces acting at the interfaces B and D along the line joining points B and D. The assumption made in step 1 is that these are tensile forces on link 3. The input arm is acted on by forces at A, B, and C. Assume that the unknown reaction force at A is positive.
F14F
x
F34 3
F43
F
R14F RP
P Fcom
D
Compacting Ram (4)
y R43 x
C
R23 B
F23
Connecting Rod (3)
y Fin
F32 x
Rin B R32
F12y A
R12
F12x
Input Arm (2) © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0350.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-51-1
PROBLEM 3-51______________________________________________________ Statement:
For the compaction mechanism of Problem 3-50 and the data of Table P3-5, determine the pin forces on the compacting ram, connecting rod, and input arm.
Given:
R12 := 148.4⋅ mm θ12 := −45⋅ deg
R14E := 57.0⋅ mm θ14E := 90⋅ deg
R14F := 62.9⋅ mm θ14F := 270⋅ deg
R34 := 32.00⋅ in
R23 := 87.6⋅ mm
θ23 := 254.36⋅ deg
R32 := 42.9⋅ mm
θ32 := 74.36⋅ deg
Solution: 1.
θ43 := 74.36⋅ deg
R43 := 87.6⋅ mm
θ34 := 90⋅ deg
R34 := 15.0⋅ mm
Rin := 152.6⋅ mm θin := 225⋅ deg Fcom := 100⋅ N
θ34 := −105.64⋅ deg
RP := 105.0⋅ mm θP := 270⋅ deg
θ3 := 254.36⋅ deg
See Mathcad files P0350 and P0351.
Draw free-body diagrams of each element (see Problem 3-50).
y
F43
R14E
E
F14E
R34
D
D
x
F34
y
F14F
R43
R14F
F θ3
RP
P
x
Fcom
R23
Compacting Ram (4)
B C
F23 y Connecting Rod (3)
Fin
F32 x
Rin B R32 Input Arm (2)
F12y A
R12
F12x
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0351.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 2.
3.
4.
3-51-2
Calculate the x- and y-components of the position vectors. R12x := R12⋅ cos( θ12)
R12x = 104.935 ⋅ mm
R12y := R12⋅ sin( θ12)
R12y = −104.935 ⋅ mm
R14Ex := R14E⋅ cos( θ14E)
R14Ex = 0 ⋅ mm
R14Ey := R14E⋅ sin( θ14E)
R14Ey = 57.000⋅ mm
R14Fx := R14F ⋅ cos( θ14F )
R14Fx = −0.000⋅ mm
R14Fy := R14F ⋅ sin( θ14F )
R14Fy = −62.900⋅ mm
R23x := R23⋅ cos( θ23)
R23x = −23.616⋅ mm
R23y := R23⋅ sin( θ23)
R23y = −84.357⋅ mm
R32x := R32⋅ cos( θ32)
R32x = 11.566⋅ mm
R32y := R32⋅ sin( θ32)
R32y = 41.312⋅ mm
R34x := R34⋅ cos( θ34)
R34x = 0.000⋅ mm
R34y := R34⋅ sin( θ34)
R34y = 15.000⋅ mm
R43x := R43⋅ cos( θ43)
R43x = 23.616⋅ mm
R43y := R43⋅ sin( θ43)
R43y = 84.357⋅ mm
RPx := RP⋅ cos( θP)
RPx = −0.000⋅ mm
RPy := RP⋅ sin( θP)
RPy = −105.000 ⋅ mm
Rinx := Rin⋅ cos( θin)
Rinx = −107.904 ⋅ mm
Riny := Rin⋅ sin( θin)
Riny = −107.904 ⋅ mm
Write equations 3(b) for link 4, the compacting ram.
Σ Fx:
F14E + F14F + F34x = 0
(1)
Σ Fy:
Fcom + F34y = 0
(2)
Σ Mz:
(−R14Ey⋅ F14E) + (−R14Fy⋅ F14F ) + (R34x⋅ F34y − R34y⋅ F34x) = 0
(3)
The direction (but not the sense) of F34 is known so write the equation that relates the x- and y-components of this force. F34y − F34x⋅ tan( θ3) = 0
5.
(4)
There are four unknowns in the four equations above. Solving for F14x, F14y, F34x, and F34y, 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 1 A := −R14Ey −R14Fy −R34y R34x mm mm mm mm 0 −tan( θ3) 1 0 F14E = 18.2⋅ N
6.
7.
F14F = 9.8⋅ N
0 F − com B := N 0 0 F34x = −28.0⋅ N
F14E F 14F := A − 1⋅ B⋅ N F34x F34y F34y = −100.0⋅ N
From Newton's thrid law and, since the connecting rod (3) is a two-force member F43x := −F34x
F43x = 28.0⋅ N
F43y := −F34y
F43y = 100.0⋅ N
F23x := −F43x
F23x = −28.0⋅ N
F23y := −F43y
F23y = −100.0⋅ N
Write equations 3(b) for link 2, the input arm.
Σ Fx:
F12x + F32x + Finx = 0
(5)
Σ Fy:
F12y + F32y + Finy = 0
(6)
Σ Mz:
(R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) + (R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) + (Rinx⋅ Finy − Riny⋅ Finx) = 0
(7)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0351.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 8.
3-51-3
The direction (but not the sense) of Fin is known so write the equation that relates the x- and y-components of this force. Finy − Finx⋅ tan( θin) = 0
9.
(8)
There are four unknowns in the four equations above. Solving for F12x, F12y, Finx, and Finy, since F32x := −F23x
F32x = 28⋅ N
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 −Riny Rinx A := −R12y R12x mm mm mm mm 0 −tan( θin) 1 0
F12x = 36.0⋅ N F12 :=
F12y = −36.0⋅ N
F12x2 + F12y2
F12 = 51⋅ N
F32y = 100⋅ N
F32y := −F23y −F32x N −F32y B := N −( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) N ⋅ mm 0 Finx = −64.0⋅ N Fin :=
F12x F 12y := A − 1⋅ B⋅ N Finx Finy
Finx = −64.0⋅ N
Finx2 + Finy2
Fin = 91⋅ N
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0351.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-52-1
PROBLEM 3-52 Statement:
Figure P3-23 shows a drag link slider crank mechanism. For the position shown, draw free-body diagrams of links 2 through 6 using variable names similar to those used in Case Studies 1A and 2A. Assume that the crank turns slowly enough that accelerations can be ignored. Ignore the weights of the links and any friction forces or torques.
Assumptions: 1. A two-dimensional model is adequate. 2. Inertia forces may be ignored. 3. Links 4 and 6 are three-force bodies. Solution: 1.
See Figure P3-23 and Mathcad file P0352.
Isolate each of the elements to be analyzed, starting with the slider, link 6, since the external forces on it are known. Place the known force, FP, at the point P. This is a three-force member
y F56
θ5
so the forces are coincident at point D and there is no turning moiment on the link. The angle, θ5,that link 5 makes with the horizontal axis is known. 2.
D
FP
F16
Link 5 is a two-force member with the forces acting at the interfaces C and D along the line joining points C and D. The assumption made in step 1 is that these are compressive forces on link 5.
F45
P
x
Slider block 6
C
y
x
θ5
R45
D
R65
F65
Link 5
3.
Link 4 is a three-force body with the three forces meeting at a point. The position vectors R 14, R34, and R54 will be known as will the angles,θ 3 and θ5,that links 3 and 5, respectively, make with the horizontal axis.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0352.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-52-2
C
y R34
F54
E
R54
x F14y
B
O4
F14x R14
F34
F43
Link 4
y B 4.
Link 3 is a two-force member with the forces acting at the interfaces A and B along the line joining points A and B.
x
R23 5.
R43
The crank is acted on by forces at A and O2, and a torque which we will assume to be positive (CCW). As in step 1, assume that the unknown reaction force at O2 is positive.
A
F23 Link 3
F y
12y
T F12x
R32 O2
x R12
A
F32 Link 2
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0352.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-53-1
PROBLEM 3-53 Statement:
For the drag link slider crank mechanism of Problem 3-52 and the data of Table P3-6, determine the pin forces on the slider, connecting rods, and crank and the reaction torque on the crank.
Given:
R12 := 63.5⋅ mm
θ12 := 45.38⋅ deg
R14 := 93.6⋅ mm
θ14 := −55.89⋅ deg
R23 := 63.5⋅ mm
θ23 := 267.8⋅ deg
R32 := 63.5⋅ mm
θ32 := 225.38⋅ deg
R34 := 103.5⋅ mm θ34 := 202.68⋅ deg
θ43 := 87.80⋅ deg
R45 := 190.5⋅ mm θ45 := 156.65⋅ deg
R54 := 103.5⋅ mm θ54 := 45.34⋅ deg
R65 := 190.5⋅ mm θ65 := −23.35⋅ deg
R43 := 63.5⋅ mm
θ5 := 156.65deg
FP := 85⋅ N Solution: 1.
θ3 := 87.80⋅ deg
See Mathcad files P0352 and P0353.
Draw free-body diagrams of each element (see Problem 3-52).
y F56
θ5
Slider block 6
P
FP
x
D
F16
F45
C
y
x
θ5
R45
D
Link 5
2.
R65
F65
Calculate the x- and y-components of the position vectors. R12x := R12⋅ cos( θ12)
R12x = 44.602⋅ mm
R12y := R12⋅ sin( θ12)
R12y = 45.198⋅ mm
R14x := R14⋅ cos( θ14)
R14x = 52.489⋅ mm
R14y := R14⋅ sin( θ14)
R14y = −77.497⋅ mm
R23x := R23⋅ cos( θ23)
R23x = −2.438⋅ mm
R23y := R23⋅ sin( θ23)
R23y = −63.453⋅ mm
R32x := R32⋅ cos( θ32)
R32x = −44.602⋅ mm
R32y := R32⋅ sin( θ32)
R32y = −45.198⋅ mm
R34x := R34⋅ cos( θ34)
R34x = −95.497⋅ mm
R34y := R34⋅ sin( θ34)
R34y = −39.908⋅ mm
R43x := R43⋅ cos( θ43)
R43x = 2.438⋅ mm
R43y := R43⋅ sin( θ43)
R43y = 63.453⋅ mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0353.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-53-2
R45x := R45⋅ cos( θ45)
R45x = −174.898 ⋅ mm
R45y := R45⋅ sin( θ45)
R45y = 75.504⋅ mm
R54x := R54⋅ cos( θ54)
R54x = 72.75⋅ mm
R54y := R54⋅ sin( θ54)
R54y = 73.619⋅ mm
R65x := R65⋅ cos( θ65)
R65x = 174.898 ⋅ mm
R65y := R65⋅ sin( θ65)
R65y = −75.504⋅ mm
C
F43
y
y
R34 B
F54
E
R43 x
R54
x F14y
B
O4
F14x R23
A
R14
F34
Link 4
F23 Link 3
F y
12y
T F12x
R32 O2
x R12
A
F32 Link 2 3.
4.
Write equations 3(b) for link 5, the slider.
Σ Fx:
F56x − FP = 0
(1)
Σ Fy:
F16 + F56y = 0
(2)
The direction (but not the sense) of F56 is known so write the equation that relates the x- and y-components of this force. F56y − F56x⋅ tan( θ5) = 0
5.
There are three unknowns in the three equations above. Solving for F56x, F56y, and F16,
(3)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0353.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
FP N B := 0 0
0 0 1 0 1 1 A := −tan( θ5) 1 0
F56x = 85.0⋅ N 6.
3-53-3
F56y = −36.7⋅ N
F56x −1 F56y := A ⋅ B⋅ N F 16 F16 = 36.7⋅ N
From Newton's thrid law and, since the connecting rod (5) is a two-force member F65x := −F56x
F65x = −85⋅ N
F65y := −F56y
F65y = 36.7⋅ N
F45x := −F65x
F45x = 85⋅ N
F45y := −F65y
F45y = −36.7⋅ N
F54x = −85⋅ N
F54y := −F45y
F54y = 36.7⋅ N
and, for link 4 F54x := −F45x 7.
8.
Write equations 3(b) for link 4, the rocker.
Σ Fx:
F34x + F54x + F14x = 0
(4)
Σ Fy:
F34y + F54y + F14y = 0
(5)
Σ Mz:
(R14x⋅ F14y − R14y⋅ F14x) + (R34x⋅ F34y − R34y⋅ F34x) + (R54x⋅ F54y − R54y⋅ F54x) = 0
The direction (but not the sense) of F34 is known so write the equation that relates the x- and y-components of this force. F34y − F34x⋅ tan( θ3) = 0
9.
(7)
There are four unknowns in the four equations above. Solving for F34x, F34y, F14x, and F14y,
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 A := −R34y R34x −R14y R14x mm mm mm mm 0 0 −tan( θ3) 1
F34x = 3.5⋅ N
F34y = 90.9⋅ N
−F54x N −F54y B := N −( R54x⋅ F54y − R54y⋅ F54x) N ⋅ mm 0 F14x = 81.5⋅ N
F34x F 34y := A − 1⋅ B⋅ N F14x F14y
F14y = −127.6⋅ N
10. From Newton's thrid law and, since the connecting rod (3) is a two-force member F43x := −F34x
F43x = −3.5⋅ N
F43y := −F34y
F43y = −90.9⋅ N
F23x := −F43x
F23x = 3 ⋅ N
F23y := −F43y
F23y = 90.9⋅ N
F32x = −3.5⋅ N
F32y := −F23y
F32y = −90.9⋅ N
and, for link 2 F32x := −F23x
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0353.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
3-53-4
11. Write equations 3(b) for link 2, the crank.
Σ Fx:
F12x + F32x = 0
(8)
Σ Fy:
F12y + F32y = 0
(9)
Σ Mz:
T2 + ( R12x⋅ F12y − R12y⋅ F12x) + ( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) = 0
(10)
12. There are three unknowns in the three equations above. Solving for F12x, F12y, and T2
0 0 1 0 1 0 A := −R12y R12x mm mm 1
F12x = 3.5 N
−F32x N −F32y B := N −( R32x⋅ F32y − R32y⋅ F32x) N ⋅ mm
F12y = 90.9
N
F12x −1 F12y := A ⋅ B T 2
T2 = −7796
N*mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0353.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-1a-1
PROBLEM 4-1a Statement:
A differential stress element has a set of applied stresses on it as indicated in each row of Table P4-1. For row a, draw the stress element showing the applied stresses, find the principal stresses and maximum shear stress using Mohr's circle diagram, and draw the rotated stress element showing the principal stresses.
Given:
σx := 1000
σy := 0
σz := 0
τxy := 500
τyz := 0
τzx := 0
Solution:
See Figure 4-1a and Mathcad file P0401a.
500 y
1. Draw the stress element, indicating the x and y axes.
1000
x
2. Draw the Mohr's circle axes, indicating the τ and σ axes with CW up and CCW down. 3. Plot the positive x-face point, which is (+1000, -500), and label it with an "x."
FIGURE 4-1aA
4. Plot the positive y-face point, which is (0, +500), and label it with a "y."
Stress Element for Problem 4-1a
5. Draw a straight line from point x to point y. Using the point where this line intersects the σ-axis as the center of the Mohr circle, draw a circle that goes through points x and y. 6. The center of the circle will be at
σc :=
σx + σy
σc = 500
2
7. The circle will intersect the σ-axis at two of the principal stresses. In this case, we see that one is positive and the other is negative so they will be σ1 and σ3. The third principal stress is σ2 = 0. 2
8. Calculate the radius of the circle
σx − σy 2 + τxy 2
R :=
R = 707.1
τ CW
τ CW
τ1-3 τ 1-2 500
500
y
-500
500 σ3
1000
1500 σ
0
σ1
τ2-3
-500 σ3
500
1000
1500 σ
0
σ2
σ1
2φ
500
x
τ CCW
500
τ CCW
FIGURE 4-1aB 2D and 3D Mohr's Circle Diagrams for Problem 4-1a © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0401a.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 9. Calculate the principal stresses
4-1a-2
σ1 := σc + R
σ1 = 1207
σ3 := σc − R
σ3 = −207
σ2 := 0
10. Draw the three Mohr's circles to represent the complete 3D stress state. y
11. Calculate the principal shear stresses
τ12 := 0.5⋅ ( σ1 − σ2)
τ12 = 603.6
τ23 := 0.5⋅ ( σ2 − σ3)
τ23 = 103.6
τ13 := 0.5⋅ ( σ1 − σ3)
τ13 = 707.1
207 1207 22.5° x
The maximum principal stress is always τ13. 12. Determine the orientation of the principal normal stress (σ1) with respect to the x-axis. From the 2D Mohr's circle diagram, we see that the angle 2φ from x to σ1 is CCW and is given by
σx − σc ϕ := ⋅ acos 2 R 1
ϕ = 22.5 deg
FIGURE 4-1aC Rotated Stress Element for Problem 4-1a
13. Draw the rotated 2D stress element showing the two nonzero principal stresses.
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0401a.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-1h-1
PROBLEM 4-1h Statement:
A differential stress element has a set of applied stresses on it as indicated in each row of Table P4-1. For row h, draw the stress element showing the applied stresses, find the principal stresses and maximum shear stress and draw the Mohr's circle diagram.
Given:
σx := 750
σy := 500
σz := 250
τxy := 500
τyz := 0
τzx := 0
Solution:
See Figures 4-1h and Mathcad file P0401h.
z 250
1. Calculate the coefficients (stress invariants) of equation (4.4c). 3
C2 := σx + σy + σz
C2 = 1.500 × 10
σx τxy σx τzx σy τyz + + τxy σy τzx σz τyz σz
C1 :=
750
5
C1 = 4.375 × 10
500
500
x
σx τxy τzx C0 := τxy σy τyz τ τ σ zx yz z
7
y
FIGURE 4-1hA
C0 = 3.125 × 10
Stress Element for Problem 4-1h 3
2. Find the roots of the triaxial stress equation:
−C0 C1 v := −C2 1
500
r := polyroots ( v)
2
σ − C2⋅ σ + C 1⋅ σ − C0 = 0
110 r = 250 1140 τ CW
3. Extract the principal stresses from the vector r by inspection.
σ1 := r
σ1 = 1140
3
σ2 := r
σ2 = 250
σ3 := r
σ3 = 110
2 1
τ12 := τ23 :=
τ2-3
-500
4. Using equations (4.5), evaluate the principal shear stresses.
τ13 :=
τ1-3 τ 1-2
500
σ1 − σ3 2
σ1 − σ2 2
σ2 − σ3 2
τ13 = 515
500
1000
1500
σ
0
σ3
σ2
σ1
500
τ12 = 445 τ23 = 70
τ CCW
FIGURE 4-1hB 5. Draw the three-circle Mohr diagram.
The Three Mohr's Circles for Problem 4-1h
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-2-1
PROBLEM 4-2 Statement:
A 400-lb chandelier is to be hung from two 10-ft-long solid steel cables in tension. Choose a suitable diameter for the cable such that the stress will not exceed 5000 psi. What will be the deflection of the cables? State all assumptions.
Given:
Weight of chandelier Length of cable Allowable stress
W := 400⋅ lbf L := 10⋅ ft L = 120 in σallow := 5000⋅ psi
Number of cables
N := 2
Young's modulus
E := 30⋅ 10 ⋅ psi
6
Assumptions: The cables share the load equally. Solution:
See Mathcad file P0402. W
1.
Determine the load on each cable
2.
The stress in each cable will be equal to the load on the cable divided by its cross-sectional area. Using equation (4.7), and setting the stress equal to the allowable stress, we have
P :=
P = 200 lbf
N
4⋅ P
σallow =
π⋅ d 3.
2
Solve this equation for the unknown cable diameter. d :=
4⋅ P
d = 0.226 in
π⋅ σallow
4.
Round this up to the next higher decimal equivalent of a common fractional size:
5.
Using equation (4.8), determine the deflection in each cable. Cross-section area
Cable deflection
A :=
π⋅ d
∆s :=
2
4 P⋅ L A ⋅E
d := 0.250⋅ in
2
A = 0.049 in
∆s = 0.016 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0402.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-3-1
PROBLEM 4-3 Statement:
For the bicycle pedal-arm assembly in Figure 4-1 with rider-applied force of 1500 N at the pedal, determine the maximum principal stress in the pedal arm if its cross-section is 15 mm in dia. The pedal attaches to the pedal arm with a 12-mm screw thread. What is the stress in the pedal screw?
Given:
Distances (see figure) Rider-applied force
a 170 mm Frider 1.5 kN
Pedal arm diameter
d pa 15 mm
Screw thread diameter
d sc 12 mm
b 60 mm
z
Solution:
See Figure 4-3 and Mathcad file P0403. a
1. From the FBD in Figure 4-3A (and on the solution for Problem 3-3), we see that the force from the rider is reacted in the pedal arm internally by a moment, a torque, and a vertical shear force. There are two points at section C (Figure 4-3B) that we should investigate, one at z = 0.5 d pa (point A), and one at y = 0.5 d pa (point B).
Frider a Mc = 0
M x:
Frider b Tc = 0
Mc
b
Arm y
Fc Pedal x
2. Refering to the FBD resulting from taking a section through the arm at C, the maximum bending moment Mc is found by summing moments about the y-axis, and the maximum torque Tc is found by summing moments about the x-axis. M y:
Tc
C
Frider
FIGURE 4-3A Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-3
z
Section C
A Maximum bending moment: Mc Frider a
Mc 255 N m
Maximum torque: Tc Frider b
Fc Frider
3.
x
Tc 90 N m
Vertical shear:
B
Arm
y FIGURE 4-3B
Fc 1.500 kN
Points A and B at Section C
Determine the stress components at point A where we have the effects of bending and torsion, but where the transverse shear due to bending is zero because A is at the outer fiber. Looking down the z-axis at a stress element on the surface at A, Distance to neutral axis
cpa 0.5 d pa
cpa 7.5 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 4
π d pa
Moment of inertia of pedal-arm
Ipa
Bending stress (x-direction)
σx
Stress in y-direction
σy 0 MPa
Torsional stress due to Tc
τxy
Principal stresses at A, equation (4.6a)
Mc cpa
Tc cpa
τxy 135.8 MPa
2 Ipa
σx σy 2
σx σy 2
CW
2 σx σy 2 τxy 2 2 σx σy 2 τxy 2
σ2A 0 MPa
σ3A 23 MPa
Determine the stress components at point B where we have the effects of transverse shear and torsion, but where the bending stress is zero because B is on the neutral plane. Looking down the y-axis at a stress element at B, 2
π d pa
Cross-section area of pedal-arm
Apa
Torsional stress due to Tc and shear stress due to Fc
τzx
Normal stresses
σx 0 MPa
Principal stresses at B
σ1B 124 MPa
Apa 176.7 mm
4 4 Fc τxy 3 Apa
σ1B
σ3B
5.
4
σx 769.6 MPa
Ipa
σ1A
σ1A 793 MPa
3
Ipa 2.485 10 mm
64
σ3A
4.
4-3-2
τzx 124.5 MPa
CW
σz 0 MPa σx σz 2
σx σz 2
2 σx σz 2 τzx 2 2 σx σz 2 τzx 2
σ2B 0 MPa
The maximum principal stress is at point A and is
2
σ3B 124 MPa
σ1A 793 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 6.
4-3-3
Determine the stress in the pedal screw. Bending moment
Msc Frider b
Msc 90 N m
Distance to neutral axis
csc 0.5 d sc
csc 6 mm
Moment of inertia of pedal screw
Isc
Bending stress (y-direction)
σy
Stress in z-direction
σz 0 MPa
Torsional stress
τxy 0 MPa
4
π d sc
3
Isc 1.018 10 mm
64 Msc csc Isc
4
σy 530.5 MPa
Since there is no shear stress present at the top of the screw where the bending stress is a maximum, the maximum principal stress in the pedal screw is
σ1 σy
σ1 530.5 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-4-1
PROBLEM 4-4 Statement:
The trailer hitch shown in Figure P4-2 and Figure 1-1 (p. 12) has loads applied as defined in Problem 3-4. The tongue weight of 100 kg acts downward and the pull force of 4905 N acts horizontally. Using the dimensions of the ball bracket shown in Figure 1-5 (p. 15), determine: (a) The principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. (b) The bearing stress in the ball bracket hole. (c) The tearout stress in the ball bracket. (d) The normal and shear stresses in the 19-mm diameter attachment holes. (e) The principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever.
Given:
a 40 mm b 31 mm Mtongue 100 kg Fpull 4.905 kN
c 70 mm d sh 26 mm
d 20 mm t 19 mm
Assumptions: 1. The nuts are just snug-tight (no pre-load), which is the worst case. 2. All reactions will be concentrated loads rather than distributed loads or pressures. Solution:
See Figure 4-4 and Mathcad file P0404. Wtongue Mtongue g
1. The weight on the tongue is
Wtongue 0.981 kN
2. Solving first for the reactions on the ball by summing the horizontal and vertical forces and the moments about A. W tongue 70 = c
1
F pull
1
40 = a 2
A B
A
19 = t B
F b1
31 = b
F a1x
C
F a1y 20 = d
F a2y
D
Fa2x 2
Fc2x
F b2 C D
Fd2 F c2y
FIGURE 4-4A Dimensions and Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-4
Fx :
Fpull Fa1x Fb1 = 0
(1)
Fy :
Fa1y Wtongue = 0
(2)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. MA:
4-4-2
Fb1 t Fpull a = 0
(3) Fpull a
3. Solving equation (3) for Fb1
Fb1
Fb1 10.326 kN
4. Substituting into (1) and solving for Fa1x
Fa1x Fpull Fb1
Fa1x 15.231 kN
5. Solving (2) for Fa1y
Fa1y Wtongue
Fa1y 0.981 kN
t
6. Now, refering to the FBD of the bracket, we can apply the equations of equilibrium to determine the reactions at C and D on the bracket. Fx :
Fa2x Fb2 Fc2x Fd2 = 0
(4)
Fy :
Fc2y Fa2y = 0
(5)
MC:
Fd2 d Fb2 b Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c = 0
(6)
7. Note also that the interface forces between part 1 (ball) and part 2 (bracket) have been drawn on their respective FBDs in opposite senses. Therefore, Fa2x Fa1x
Fa2y Fa1y
8. Solving equation (6) for Fd2
Fd2
Fb2 Fb1
Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c Fb2 b
Fd2 25.505 kN
d
9. Substituting into (4) and solving for Fc2x
Fc2x Fa2x Fb2 Fd2
Fc2x 30.41 kN
10. Solving (5) for Fa1y
Fc2y Fa2y
Fc2y 0.981 kN
11. Determine the principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. The internal bending moment at A on the FBD of the ball is
Distance to neutral axis
Moment of inertia of shank
Bending stress (x-direction)
M Fpull a
M 196.2 N m
csh 0.5 d sh
csh 13 mm
Ish
σx
π d sh 64 M csh Ish
Stress in y-direction
σy 0 MPa
Shear stress at A
τxy 0 MPa
4 4
Ish 2.243 10 mm
4
σx 113.7 MPa
Since the shear stress is zero, x is the maximum principal stress, thus
σ1 σx
σ1 114 MPa
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-4-3
12. Determine the bearing stress in the ball bracket hole. Bearing area
Abearing d sh t
Bearing stress
σbearing
Abearing 494 mm
Fpull
2
σbearing 9.93 MPa
Abearing
13. Determine the tearout stress in the ball bracket.
Tearout length
Shear area (see Figure 4-4B) 2
Atear = 2 t R ( 0.5 d )
2
Atear 2 t ( 32 mm) 0.5 d sh 2
Atear 1111 mm
2
2
Stress
R
d
τtear
Fpull Atear
FIGURE 4-4B Tearout Diagram for Problem 4-4
τtear 4.41 MPa d bolt 19 mm
14. Determine the normal and shear stresses in the attachment bolts if they are 19-mm dia. Bolt cross-section area (2 bolts)
Abolt 2
Normal stress (tension)
σbolt
π d bolt
Fc2x Abolt
4
2
Abolt 567.1 mm
2
σbolt 53.6 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Shear stress
τbolt
4-4-4 W tongue
Fc2y
τbolt 1.7 MPa
Abolt
1
F pull
15. Determine the principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever (see Figure 4-4C).
a
Bending moment
2
M Fpull a Wtongue c Width of bracket Moment of inertia Total tensile stress
M 264.8 N m M
w 64 mm I
w t
R
3
I 36581 mm
12
σ
c
M t 2 I
Fpull w t
4
FIGURE 4-4C Cantilever FBD for Problem 4-4
σ 72.8 MPa
Since there are no shear stress at the top and bottom of the bracket where the bending stresses are maximum, they are also the principal stresses, thus
σ1 σ τmax
σ1 72.8 MPa σ 2
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
τmax 36.4 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-5-1
PROBLEM 4-5 Statement:
Repeat Problem 4-4 for the loading conditions of Problem 3-5, i.e., determine the stresses due to a horizontal force that will result on the ball from accelerating a 2000-kg trailer to 60 m/sec in 20 se Assume a constant acceleration. From Problem 3-5, the pull force is 6000 N. Determine: (a) The principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. (b) The bearing stress in the ball bracket hole. (c) The tearout stress in the ball bracket. (d) The normal and shear stresses in the 19-mm diameter attachment holes. (e) The principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever.
Given:
a 40 mm b 31 mm Mtongue 100 kg Fpull 6 kN
c 70 mm d sh 26 mm
d 20 mm t 19 mm
Assumptions: 1. The nuts are just snug-tight (no pre-load), which is the worst case. 2. All reactions will be concentrated loads rather than distributed loads or pressures. Solution:
See Figure 4-5 and Mathcad file P0405.
1. The weight on the tongue is
Wtongue Mtongue g
Wtongue 0.981 kN
2. Solving first for the reactions on the ball by summing the horizontal and vertical forces and the moments about A. W tongue 70 = c
1
F pull
1
40 = a 2
A B
A
19 = t B
F b1
31 = b
F a1x
C
F a1y 20 = d
F a2y
D
Fa2x 2
Fc2x
F b2 C D
Fd2 F c2y
FIGURE 4-5A Dimensions and Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-5
Fx :
Fpull Fa1x Fb1 = 0
(1)
Fy :
Fa1y Wtongue = 0
(2)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. MA:
4-5-2
Fb1 t Fpull a = 0
(3) Fpull a
3. Solving equation (3) for Fb1
Fb1
Fb1 12.632 kN
4. Substituting into (1) and solving for Fa1x
Fa1x Fpull Fb1
Fa1x 18.632 kN
5. Solving (2) for Fa1y
Fa1y Wtongue
Fa1y 0.981 kN
t
6. Now, refering to the FBD of the bracket, we can apply the equations of equilibrium to determine the reactions at C and D on the bracket. Fx :
Fa2x Fb2 Fc2x Fd2 = 0
(4)
Fy :
Fc2y Fa2y = 0
(5)
MC:
Fd2 d Fb2 b Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c = 0
(6)
7. Note also that the interface forces between part 1 (ball) and part 2 (bracket) have been drawn on their respective FBDs in opposite senses. Therefore, Fa2x Fa1x
Fa2y Fa1y
8. Solving equation (6) for Fd2
Fd2
Fb2 Fb1
Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c Fb2 b
Fd2 30.432 kN
d
9. Substituting into (4) and solving for Fc2x
Fc2x Fa2x Fb2 Fd2
Fc2x 36.432 kN
10. Solving (5) for Fa1y
Fc2y Fa2y
Fc2y 0.981 kN
11. Determine the principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. The internal bending moment at A on the FBD of the ball is
Distance to neutral axis
Moment of inertia of shank
Bending stress (x-direction)
M Fpull a
M 240 N m
csh 0.5 d sh
csh 13 mm
Ish
σx
π d sh
4
64 M csh Ish
Stress in y-direction
σy 0 MPa
Shear stress at A
τxy 0 MPa
4
Ish 2.243 10 mm
4
σx 139.1 MPa
Since the shear stress is zero, x is the maximum principal stress, thus
σ1 σx
σ1 139 MPa
12. Determine the bearing stress in the ball bracket hole.
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. Bearing area
Abearing d sh t
Bearing stress
σbearing
4-5-3 Abearing 494 mm
Fpull
2
σbearing 12.15 MPa
Abearing
13. Determine the tearout stress in the ball bracket.
Tearout length
Shear area (see Figure 4-4B) 2
Atear = 2 t R ( 0.5 d )
2
Atear 2 t ( 32 mm) 0.5 d sh 2
Atear 1111 mm
2
2
Stress
R
d
τtear
Fpull Atear
FIGURE 4-5B
τtear 5.4 MPa
Tearout Diagram for Problem 4-5
d bolt 19 mm
14. Determine the normal and shear stresses in the attachment bolts if they are 19-mm dia. Bolt cross-section area (2 bolts)
Abolt 2
σbolt
Normal stress (tension)
π d bolt
2
Abolt 567.1 mm
4
Fc2x
σbolt 64.2 MPa
Abolt
Shear stress
τbolt
2
W tongue
Fc2y
τbolt 1.7 MPa
Abolt
1
F pull
15. Determine the principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever (see Figure 4-4C).
a
Bending moment
2
M Fpull a Wtongue c Width of bracket Moment of inertia
M 308.6 N m M
w 64 mm I
w t
c R
3
I 36581 mm
12
4
FIGURE 4-5C Cantilever FBD for Problem 4-5
Total tensile stress
σ
M t 2 I
Fpull w t
σ 85.1 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-5-4
Since there are no shear stress at the top and bottom of the bracket where the bending stresses are maximum, they are also the principal stresses, thus
σ1 σ τmax
σ1 85.1 MPa σ 2
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
τmax 42.5 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-6-1
PROBLEM 4-6 Statement:
Repeat Problem 4-4 for the loading conditions of Problem 3-6, i.e., determine the stresses due to a horizontal force that will results from an impact between the ball and the tongue of the 2000-kg trailer if the hitch deflects 2.8 mm dynamically on impact. The tractor weighs 1000 kg and the velocity at impact is 0.3 m/sec. Determine: (a) The principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. (b) The bearing stress in the ball bracket hole. (c) The tearout stress in the ball bracket. (d) The normal and shear stresses in the 19-mm diameter attachment holes. (e) The principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever.
Given:
a 40 mm b 31 mm Mtongue 100 kg Fpull 55.1 kN
c 70 mm d sh 26 mm
d 20 mm t 19 mm
Assumptions: 1. The nuts are just snug-tight (no pre-load), which is the worst case. 2. All reactions will be concentrated loads rather than distributed loads or pressures. Solution:
See Figure 4-6 and Mathcad file P0406.
1. The weight on the tongue is
Wtongue Mtongue g
Wtongue 0.981 kN
2. Solving first for the reactions on the ball by summing the horizontal and vertical forces and the moments about A. W tongue 70 = c
1
F pull
1
40 = a 2
A B
A
19 = t B
F b1
31 = b
F a1x
C
F a1y 20 = d
F a2y
D
Fa2x 2
Fc2x
F b2 C D
Fd2 F c2y
FIGURE 4-6A Dimensions and Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-6
Fx :
Fpull Fa1x Fb1 = 0
(1)
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-6-2
Fy :
Fa1y Wtongue = 0
(2)
MA:
Fb1 t Fpull a = 0
(3) Fpull a
3. Solving equation (3) for Fb1
Fb1
Fb1 116 kN
4. Substituting into (1) and solving for Fa1x
Fa1x Fpull Fb1
Fa1x 171.1 kN
5. Solving (2) for Fa1y
Fa1y Wtongue
Fa1y 0.981 kN
t
6. Now, refering to the FBD of the bracket, we can apply the equations of equilibrium to determine the reactions at C and D on the bracket. Fx :
Fa2x Fb2 Fc2x Fd2 = 0
(4)
Fy :
Fc2y Fa2y = 0
(5)
MC:
Fd2 d Fb2 b Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c = 0
(6)
7. Note also that the interface forces between part 1 (ball) and part 2 (bracket) have been drawn on their respective FBDs in opposite senses. Therefore, Fa2x Fa1x
Fa2y Fa1y
8. Solving equation (6) for Fd2
Fd2
Fb2 Fb1
Fa2x ( b t) Fa2y c Fb2 b
Fd2 251.382 kN
d
9. Substituting into (4) and solving for Fc2x
Fc2x Fa2x Fb2 Fd2
Fc2x 306.482 kN
10. Solving (5) for Fa1y
Fc2y Fa2y
Fc2y 0.981 kN
11. Determine the principal stresses in the shank of the ball where it joins the ball bracket. The internal bending moment at A on the FBD of the ball is
Distance to neutral axis
Moment of inertia of shank
Bending stress (x-direction)
3
M Fpull a
M 2.204 10 N m
csh 0.5 d sh
csh 13 mm
Ish
σx
π d sh 64 M csh Ish
Stress in y-direction
σy 0 MPa
Shear stress at A
τxy 0 MPa
4 4
Ish 2.243 10 mm
4
σx 1277 MPa
Since the shear stress is zero, x is the maximum principal stress, thus
σ1 σx
σ1 1277 MPa
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-6-3
12. Determine the bearing stress in the ball bracket hole. Bearing area
Abearing d sh t
Bearing stress
σbearing
Abearing 494 mm
Fpull
2
σbearing 111.54 MPa
Abearing
13. Determine the tearout stress in the ball bracket.
Tearout length
Shear area (see Figure 4-4B) 2
Atear = 2 t R ( 0.5 d )
2
Atear 2 t ( 32 mm) 0.5 d sh 2
Atear 1111 mm
2
2
Stress
R
d
τtear
Fpull Atear
FIGURE 4-6B Tearout Diagram for Problem 4-6
τtear 49.59 MPa d bolt 19 mm
14. Determine the normal and shear stresses in the attachment bolts if they are 19-mm dia. Bolt cross-section area (2 bolts)
Abolt 2
σbolt
Normal stress (tension)
π d bolt
2
Abolt 567.1 mm
4
Fc2x
σbolt 540 MPa
Abolt
Shear stress
τbolt
2
W tongue
Fc2y
τbolt 1.7 MPa
Abolt
1
F pull
15. Determine the principal stresses in the ball bracket as a cantilever (see Figure 4-4C).
a
Bending moment
Width of bracket Moment of inertia
M 2.3 10 N m M
w 64 mm I
2
3
M Fpull a Wtongue c
w t
c R
3
I 36581 mm
12
4
FIGURE 4-6C Cantilever FBD for Problem 4-6
Total tensile stress
σ
M t 2 I
Fpull w t
σ 635.5 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-6-4
Since there are no shear stress at the top and bottom of the bracket where the bending stresses are maximum, they are also the principal stresses, thus
σ1 σ τmax
σ1 636 MPa σ 2
σ2 0 MPa
σ3 0 MPa
τmax 318 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-7-1
PROBLEM 4-7 Statement:
Design the wrist pin of Problem 3-7 for a maximum allowable principal stress of 20 ksi if the pin is hollow and loaded in double shear.
Given:
Force on wrist pin
Fwristpin 12.258 kN
Allowable stress
σallow 20 ksi od 0.375 in
Assumptions: Choose a suitable outside diameter, say Solution:
Fwristpin 2756 lbf
See Figure 4-12 in the text and Mathcad file P0407.
1. The force at each shear plane is
F
Fwristpin
F 1378 lbf
2
2. With only the direct shear acting on the plane, the Mohr diagram will be a circle with center at the origin and radius equal to the shear stress. Thus, the principal normal stress is numerically equal to the shear stress, which in this case is also the principal shear stress, so we have = 1 = allow.
3. The shear stress at each shear plane is
4. Solving for the inside diameter,
τ=
id
F A
2
=
od
4 F
2 2 π od id
4 F
π σallow
= σallow
id 0.230 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-8-1
PROBLEM 4-8 Statement:
A paper mill processes rolls of paper having a density of 984 kg/m3. The paper roll is 1.50 m outside dia (OD) by 0.22 m inside dia (ID) by 3.23 m long and is on a simply supported, hollow, steel shaft. Find the shaft ID needed to obtain a maximum deflection at the center of 3 mm if the shaft OD is 22 cm.
Given:
Paper density
ρ 984
kg 3
m Roll dimensions Outside diameter Inside diameter Lemgth
od 220 mm E 207 GPa δ 3 mm
Shaft outside dia Young's modulus Allowable deflection
OD 1.50 m ID 0.22 m L 3.23 m
Assumptions: The shaft (beam) supporting the paper roll is simply-supported at the ends and is the same length as the paper roll. The paper acts as a distributed load over the length of the shaft. Solution: 1.
See Mathcad file P0408.
The weight of the paper roll is equal to its volume times the paper density times g. Wroll
4
π
2
2
OD ID L ρ g
Wroll 53.89 kN Wroll
The intensity of the distributed load is w
3.
Using Figure B-2(b) in Appendix B with a = 0, the maximum deflection is at the midspan and is y =
w x 24 E I
2
3
w 16.686
N
2.
L
3
2 L x x L
mm
4
For x = L/2, this reduces to
y =
5 w L
384 E I 4
Letting = -y and solving for I, we have
4.
I
5 w L
7
I 3.808 10 mm
384 E δ
The area moment of inertia for a hollow circular cross-section is I =
π 64
4
4
4
od id
1
Solving this for the id yields
id od 4
Round this down (for slightly less deflection) to
64 I
4
π
id 198.954 mm
id 198 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-9-1
PROBLEM 4-9 Statement:
A ViseGrip plier-wrench is drawn to scale in Figure P4-3, and for which the forces were analyzed in Problem 3-9, find the stresses in each pin for an assumed clamping force of P = 4000 N in the position shown. The pins are 8-mm dia and are all in double shear.
Given:
Pin forces as calculated in Problem 3-9: Member 1 F21 7.5 kN
F41 5.1 kN
Member 2
F12 7.5 kN
F32 5.1 kN
Member 3
F23 5.1 kN
F43 5.1 kN
Member 4
F14 5.1 kN
F34 5.1 kN
d 8 mm
Pin diameter
Assumptions: Links 3 and 4 are in a toggle position, i.e., the pin that joins links 3 and 4 is in line with the pins that join 1 with 4 and 2 with 3. Solution: 1.
See Figure 4-9 and Mathcad file P0409.
The FBDs of the assembly and each individual link are shown in Figure 4-9. The dimensions, as scaled from Figure P4-3 in the text, are shown on the link FBDs. 4
F
P 1
2
3
P
F 55.0 = b
50.0 = a
39.5 = c
F
F14 22.0 = d
129.2°
1
4 F34
F41
F21
P
28.0 = e
F43
F12
3 F23
P
F32
2.8 = g
21.2 = h
2
F 26.9 = f
FIGURE 4-9 Free Body Diagrams for Problem 4-9
2.
The cross-sectional area for all pins is the same and is
A
π d 4
2
A 50.265 mm
2
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 3.
4-9-2
The pin that joins members 1 and 2 is the most highly stressed while the stress on each of the remaining pins is the same. Since the pins are in double shear, we will divide the pin load by 2 in each case.
Pin joining 1 and 2
τ12
All other pins
τ14
F12 2 A F14 2 A
τ12 74.6 MPa
τ14 50.7 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-10-1
PROBLEM 4-10 Statement:
Given:
The over-hung diving board of problem 3-10 is shown in Figure P4-4a. Assume cross-section dimensions of 305 mm x 32 mm. The material has E = 10.3 GPa. Find the largest principal stress at any location in the board when a 100-kg person is standing at the free end. W 100 kgf
Weight of person
2000 = L
Board dimensions
R1
Distance to support
a 0.7 m
Length of board
L 2 m
Cross-section
w 305 mm
P
R2
t 32 mm
700 = a
FIGURE 4-10 Assumptions: The weight of the beam is negligible compared to the applied load and so can be ignored. Solution: 1.
See Figure 4-10 and Mathcad file P0410.
From the FBD of the diving board and Figure B-3 (Appendix B), the reactions at the supports are R1 W 1
R2 W
L
R1 1821 N
a
L
a
2.
R2 2802 N
Also from Figure D-3, the maximum bending moment occurs at the right-hand support where, in the FBD above, x = a. Mmax R1 a
3.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-10
Mmax 1275 N m
The maximum bending stress will occur on the top and bottom surfaces of the board at the section where the maximum bending moment occurs which, in this case, is at x = a. The only stress present on the top or bottom surface of the board is the bending stress x. Therefore, on the top surface where the stress is tensile, x. is the principal stress 1 . Thus, Distance to extreme fiber
Moment of inertia
Bending stress
Maximum principal stress
c I
σx
t
c 16 mm
2 w t
3
12 Mmax c
σ1 σx
5
I 8.329 10 mm
I
4
σx 24.492 MPa σ1 24.5 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-11-1
PROBLEM 4-11 Statement:
Given:
Repeat Problem 4-10 using the loading conditions of Problem 3-11. Assume the board weighs 29 kg and deflects 13.1 cm statically when the person stands on it. Find the largest principal stress at any location in the board when the 100-kg person in Problem 4-10 jumps up 25 cm and lands back on the board. Find the maximum deflection. Beam length
L 2000 mm
Distance to support
a 700 mm
Mass of person
mpers 100 kg
Mass of board
mboard 29 kg
Static deflection
δst 131 mm
Height of jump
h 250 mm
Cross-section
w 305 mm
2000 = L R1
Fi
R2 700 = a
FIGURE 4-11
t 32 mm
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-11
Assumptions: The apparent Young's modulus for fiberglas is 4
E 1.03 10 MPa Solution:
See Figure 4-11 and Mathcad file P0411.
1. From Problem 3-11, the dynamic load resulting from the impact of the person with the board isFi 3.056 kN 2. From the FBD of the diving board and Figure B-3(a) (Appendix B), the reactions at the supports are R1 Fi 1
R2 Fi
L
R1 5.675 kN
a
L
a
R2 8.731 kN
3. Also from Figure D-3(a), the maximum bending moment occurs at the right-hand support where, in the FBD above, x = a. Mmax R1 a
Mmax 3.973 kN m
4. The maximum bending stress will occur on the top and bottom surfaces of the board at the section where the maximum bending moment occurs which, in this case, is at x = a. The only stress present on the top or bottom surface of the board is the bending stress x. Therefore, on the top surface where the stress is tensile, x is the principal stress 1 . Thus, c
Distance to extreme fiber
I
Moment of inertia
σx
Bending stress
t
c 16 mm
2 w t
3
12 Mmax c I
σ1 σx
Maximum principal stress
5
I 8.329 10 mm
4
σx 76.322 MPa σ1 76.3 MPa
5. Calculate the maximum deflection from the equation given in Figure D-3(a) at x = L. Let b in the figure be a in our problem and let a in the figure be equal to L, then ymax
Fi 6 a E I
( a L) L L ( L a ) a ( L a ) L 3
3
2
ymax 401.4 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-12-1
PROBLEM 4-12 Statement:
Repeat Problem 4-10 using the cantilevered diving board design in Figure P4-4b.
Given:
Beam length
L 1300 mm
Weight at free end
P 100 kgf
Cross-section
w 305 mm
2000 1300 = L P
t 32 mm Assumptions:
The apparent Young's modulus for fiberglas is
M1
R1
4
E 1.03 10 MPa Solution:
700
FIGURE 4-12
See Figure 4-12 and Mathcad file P0412.
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-12
1.
2.
From the FBD of the diving board and Figure B-1(a) (Appendix B), the reactions at the supports are R1 P
R1 981 N
M1 P L
M1 1275 N m
Also from Figure D-1, the maximum bending moment occurs at the support where, in the FBD above, x = 0. Mmax M1
Mmax 1275 N m
3. The maximum bending stress will occur on the top and bottom surfaces of the board at the section where the maximum bending moment occurs which, in this case, is at x = 0. The only stress present on the top or bottom surface of the board is the bending stress x. Therefore, on the top surface where the stress is tensile, x is the principal stress 1 . Thus, Distance to extreme fiber
Moment of inertia
Bending stress
Maximum principal stress
c I
σx
t
c 16 mm
2 w t
3
12 Mmax c
σ1 σx
5
I 8.329 10 mm
I
4
σx 24.492 MPa σ1 24.5 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-13-1
PROBLEM 4-13 Statement:
Given:
Repeat Problem 4-11 using the diving board design shown in Figure P4-4b. Assume the board weighs 19 kg and deflects 8.5 cm statically when the person stands on it. Unsupported length
L 1300 mm
Mass of board
mboard 19 kg
Static board deflection
δstat 85 mm
Mass of person
mperson 100 kg
Height of jump
h 250 mm
Cross-section
w 305 mm
2000 1300 = L Fi
M1
t 32 mm
R1
700
Assumptions: The apparent Young's modulus for fiberglas is FIGURE 4-13
4
E 1.03 10 MPa Solution:
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-13
See Figure 4-13 and Mathcad file P0413.
1.
From Problem 3-13, the dynamic load resulting from the impact of the person with the board isFi 3.487 kN
2.
From the FBD of the diving board and Figure B-1(a) (Appendix B), the reactions at the supports are
3.
R1 Fi
R1 3487 N
M1 Fi L
M1 4533 N m
Also from Figure D-1, the maximum bending moment occurs at the support where, in the FBD above, x = 0. Mmax M1 Mmax 4533 N m
4. The maximum bending stress will occur on the top and bottom surfaces of the board at the section where the maximum bending moment occurs which, in this case, is at x = 0. The only stress present on the top or bottom surface of the board is the bending stress x. Therefore, on the top surface where the stress is tensile, x is the principal stress 1 . Thus, Distance to extreme fiber
Moment of inertia
Bending stress
Maximum principal stress 5.
c I
σx
t
c 16 mm
2 w t
3
5
I 8.329 10 mm
12 Mmax c
4
σx 87.086 MPa
I
σ1 σx
σ1 87.1 MPa
Calculate the maximum deflection from the equation given in Figure D-3(a) at x = L. Let b in the figure be a in our problem and let a in the figure be equal to L, then 3
ymax
Fi L
3 E I
ymax 297.7 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-14-1
PROBLEM 4-14 Statement:
Figure P4-5 shows a child's toy called a pogo stick. The child stands on the pads, applying half her weight on each side. She jumps off the ground, holding the pads up against her feet, and bounces along with the spring cushioning the impact and storing energy to help each rebound. Design the aluminum cantilever beam sections on which she stands to survive jumping 2 in off the ground. Assume an allowable stress of 20 ksi. Define and size the beam shape.
Given:
Allowable stress
σallow 20 ksi
Young's modulus
E 10.3 10 psi
6
Assumptions: The beam will have a rectangular cross-section with the load applied at a distance of 5 in from the central support. L 5 in Solution:
See Figure 4-14 and Mathcad file P0414.
1. From Problem 3-14, the total dynamic force on both foot supports is Fi 224 lbf
Fi /2
Therefore, the load on each support is P
Fi
Fi /2
P 112 lbf
2
2. To give adequate support to the childs foot, let the width of the support beam be w 1.5 in 3. From Figure B-1(a) in Appendix B, the maximum bending moment at x = 0 is M P L 4.
We can now calculate the minimum required section modulus, Z = I/c.
Bending stress Solving for Z,
5.
P
M 560 in lbf
σ= Z
For a rectangular cross-section, I =
Solving for t,
M
M
t
Z 458.8 mm
σallow 3
12
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-14
= σallow
Z
w t
FIGURE 4-14
and c =
6 Z w
t 2
so Z =
w t
3
2
6
t 0.335 in
Round this up to the next higher decimal equivalent of a common fraction,
t 0.375 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-15-1
PROBLEM 4-15 Statement:
Design a shear pin for the propeller shaft of an outboard motor if the shaft through which the pin is placed is 25-mm diameter, the propeller is 20-cm diameter, and the pin must fail when a force > 400 N is applied to the propeller tip. Assume an ultimate shear strength for the pin material of 100 MPa.
Given:
Propeller shaft dia Propeller dia Max propeller tip force
d 25 mm D 200 mm Fmax 400 N
Ultimate shear strength
S us 100 MPa
Fpin
T
Propeller Hub
Shear Pin
Assumptions: A shear pin is in direct, double shear. Solution:
Fpin
See Figure 4-15 and Mathcad file P0415.
d
FIGURE 4-15
1. Calculate the torque on the propeller shaft that will result from a tip force on the propeller of Fmax. T Fmax 2.
2
Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-15
T 40000 N mm
This will be reacted by the shear pin's couple on the shaft. Determine the magnitude of the direct shear force. Fpin
3.
D
Propeller Shaft
T d
Fpin 1600 N
Determine the maximum pin diameter that will shear at this force.
Direct shear stress
τ=
Fpin A
=
4 Fpin
π d pin 4 Fpin
Solving for the pin diameter
d pin
Round this to
d pin 4.5 mm
π S us
2
= S us
d pin 4.514 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-16-1
PROBLEM 4-16 Statement:
Given:
A track to guide bowling balls is designed with two round rods as shown in Figure P4-6. The rods are not parallel to one another but have a small angle between them. The balls roll on the rods until they fall between them and drop onto another track. The angle between the rods is varied to cause the ball to drop at different locations. Find the maximum stress and deflection in the rods assuming that they are (a) simply supported at each end, and (b) fixed at each end. Rod length
L 30 in
Rod diameter
d 1.00 in
Distance to load
a 23.15 in
Young's modulus
E 30 10 psi
Fball
a
6
R1
Assumptions: The analysis of Problem 3-16 yielded the following for a simply supported beam:
R2
L
FIGURE 4-16A Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-16(a), taken on a plane through the rod axis and ball center
Max ball load
Fball 13.89 lbf
Max moment
Mmax 73.4 in lbf
Reactions
R1 3.17 lbf R2 10.72 lbf
Solution:
See Figure 4-16 and Mathcad file P0416.
1. The maximum bending stress will occur at the outer fibers of the rod at the section where the maximum bending moment occurs which, in this case, is at x = a. The only stress present on the top or bottom surface of the rod is the bending stress x. Therefore, on the bottom surface where the stress is tensile, x is the principal stress 1 . Thus, for a simply supported rod, c
Distance to extreme fiber
I
Moment of inertia
σx
Bending stress
c 0.5 in
2
π d
4
4
I 0.0491 in
64 Mmax c
σx 748 psi
I
σ1 σx
Maximum principal stress 2.
d
σ1 748 psi
Calculate the maximum deflection for the simply supported case from the equation given in Figure D-2(a), ymax
Fball 6 E I
2 a
3
a
4
L
L a
2
3. For the case where the rod is built in at each end, the beam is statically indeterminate. As seen in Figure 4-16B, there are four unknown reactions and only two equilibrium equations can be written using statics. We will find the reactions using Example 4-7 as a model.
ymax 0.0013 in Fball
a
M1
R1
L
R 2 M2
FIGURE 4-16B Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-16(b), taken on a plane through the rod axis and ball center
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-16-2
4. Write an equation for the load function in terms of equations 3.17 and integrate the resulting function four times using equations 3.18 to obtain the shear and moment functions. Note use of the unit doublet function to represent the moment at the wall. For the beam in Figure 4-16B, q(x) = -M1-2 + R1-1 - F-1 + R2-1 + M2-2 V(x) = -M1-1 + R10 - F0
+ R2
- L>0 + M2-1 + C1
M(x) = -M10 + R11 - F1 + R21 + M20 + C1x+ C2 (x) = ( -M11 + R12/2 - F2/2
+ R2
- L>2/2 + M21 + C1x2/2 + C2x + C3) / EI
y(x) = ( -M12/2 + R13/6 - F3/6 + R23/6 + M22 /2+ C1x3/6 + C2x2/2 + C3x + C4) / EI 5. Because the reactions have been included in the loading function, the shear and moment diagrams both close to zero at each end of the beam, making C1 = C2 = 0. This leaves six unknowns; the four reactions and the constants of integration, C3 and C4. There are four boundary conditions that we can use and two equilibrium equations. The boundary conditions are: at x = 0, = 0 and y = 0; and at x = L, = 0 and y = 0. Applying the boundary conditions at x = 0 results in C3 = C4 = 0. Applying the BCs at x = L results in the following two equations, which are solved for R1 and M1. At x = L,
θ=0
0=
y =0
0=
R1 2 R1 6
2
L M 1 L 3
L
M1 2
2
F 2
L
( L a) F 6
2
( L a)
3
Solving these two equations simultaneously for R1 and M1, M1
Fball
R1 2
6.
L M1 L
( L a)
( L a ) 2
Fball
L
( L a)
3
M1 16.765 in lbf
2
2
R1 1.842 lbf
L
The remaing two reactions can be found by using the equations of equilibrium.
Fy = 0:
R1 Fball R2 = 0
M = 0:
M1 Fball a R2 L M2 = 0
Solving these two equations simultaneously for R2 and M2,
7.
R2 Fball R1
R2 12.048 lbf
M2 M1 Fball a R2 L
M2 56.657 in lbf
Define the range for x, x 0 in 0.005 L L
8. For a Mathcad solution, define a step function S. This function will have a value of zero when x is less than z, and a value of one when it is greater than or equal to z. S ( x z) if ( x z 1 0 ) 9. Write the shear, moment, slope, and deflection equations in Mathcad form, using the function S as a multiplying factor to get the effect of the singularity functions. © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-16-3
V ( x) R1 S ( x 0 mm) Fball S ( x a ) R2 S ( x L) M ( x) M1 S ( x 0 mm) R1 S ( x 0 mm) ( x 0 mm) Fball S ( x a ) ( x a ) M2 S ( x L) R2 S ( x L) ( x L)
θ ( x)
y ( x)
1 E I
1 E I
M1 S ( x 0 mm) x
R1 2
2
S ( x 0 mm) ( x 0 mm)
Fball 2
R M2 S( x L) ( x L) 2 S( x L) ( x L) 2 2
M1
2
S ( x 0 mm) x
2 M2
R1 6
3
S ( x 0 mm) ( x 0 mm)
Fball
R S ( x L) ( x L) 2 2 S ( x L) ( x L) 3 6 2
2
S ( x a ) ( x a )
6
3
S ( x a ) ( x a )
10. Plot the shear, moment, slope, and deflection diagrams. (a) Shear Diagram
(b) Moment Diagram
5
40 20 Moment, M - lb in
Shear, V - lb
0
5
10
15
0 20 40
0
10
20
60
30
0
Distance along beam, x - in
30
(d) Deflection Diagram 0 Deflection - thousandths of in
0.1 Slope - Thousands of Rad
20
Distance along beam, x - in
(c) Slope Diagram
0
0.1
10
0
10
20
30
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
Distance along beam, x - in
0
10
20
30
Distance along beam, x - in
FIGURE 4-16C Shear, Moment, Slope, and Deflection Diagrams for Problem 4-16(b) © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-16-4
11 The maximum moment occurs at x = L and is Mmax M2
Mmax 56.7 in lbf
12 Calculate the maximum bending and principal stresses.
σx
Bending stress
Mmax c I
σ1 σx
Maximum principal stress
σx 577 psi σ1 577 psi
13. To find the maximum deflection, first determine at what point on the beam the slope is zero. Let this be at x = e. From the slope diagram, we see that e < a. Using the slope equation and setting it equal to zero, we have For = 0
0 = M1 e
Solving for e
e
Maximum deflection
2 M1 R1
ymax y ( e)
R1 2 e 2 e 18.204 in ymax 0.00063 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-17-1
PROBLEM 4-17 Statement:
A pair of ice tongs is shown in Figure P4-7. The ice weighs 50 lb and is 10 in wide across the tongs. The distance between the handles is 4 in, and the mean radius r of the tong is 6 in. The rectangular cross-sectional dimensions are 0.75 x 0.312 in. Find the stress in the tongs.
Given:
Assumptions: beam.
Mean radius of tong
rc 6.00 in
Tong width
w 0.312 in
Tong depth
h 0.75 in
F C FC O
The tong can be analyzed as a curved 11.0 = ax
See Problem 3-17, Figure 4-17, Solution: and Mathcad file P0417.
3.5 = cy
FO 2.0 = cx
A
12.0 = by 5.0 = bx
1. The maximum bending moment and axial force in the tong were found in Problem 3-17 at point A. They are
FB B
Maximum moment
MA 237.5 in lbf
Axial force at D
FAn 25 lbf
W/2 FIGURE 4-17 Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-17
2.
3.
Calculate the section area, inside radius and outside radus. A h w
A 0.234 in
Inside and outside radii of section
ri rc 0.5 h
ri 5.625 in
ro rc 0.5 h
ro 6.375 in
Use the equation in the footnote on page 195 of the text to calculate the radius of the neutral axis. Radius of neutral axis
4.
rn
ro ri
ro ln ri
rn 5.992 in
Calculate the eccentricty and the distances from the neutral axis to the extreme fibers. Eccentricity
e rc rn
e 0.007821 in
Distances from neutral axis to extreme fibers
ci rn ri
ci 0.3672 in
co ro rn
co 0.3828 in
Stresses at inner and outer radii
σi
MA c i FAn e A ri A
MA co FAn A e A ro
σo 5.
2
Area of section
σi 8.58 ksi
σo 7.69 ksi
The shear stress is zero at the outer fibers. Therefore, these are the principal stresses. At the inner surface
σ1 σi
σ1 8.58 ksi
σ2 0 ksi
σ3 0 ksi
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-18-1
PROBLEM 4-18 Statement:
A set of steel reinforcing rods is to be stretched axially in tension to create a tensile stress of 30 ksi prior to being cast in concrete to form a beam. Determine how much force will be required to stretch them the required amount and how much deflection is required. There are 10 rods; each is 0.75-in diameter and 30 ft long.
Given:
Desired stress
σ 30 ksi
Rod diameter
d 0.75 in
Number of rods Rod length
Nrods 10 L 30 ft
Young's modulus
E 30 10 psi
6
Assumptions: The rods share the load equally. Solution:
See Mathcad file P0418.
π d
2
2
1.
Calculate the cross-sectional area of one rod. A
2.
Determine the force required to achieve the desired stress level in one rod.
σ= 3.
F A
4
F 13.254 kip
Determine the total force required to achieve the desired stress level in all rods. Ftotal Nrods F
4.
F σ A
A 0.442 in
Ftotal 132.5 kip
Determine the amount the rods will deflect under the applied load.
δ
F L A E
δ 0.360 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-19-1
PROBLEM 4-19 Statement:
The clamping fixture used to pull the rods in Problem 4-18 is conected to the hydraulic ram by a clevis like that shown in Figure P4-8. Determine the size of the clevis pin needed to withstand the applied force. Assume an allowable shear stress of 20 000 psi and an allowable normal stress of 40 000 psi. Determine the required outside radius of the clevis end to not exceed the above allowable stresses in either tear out or bearing if the clevis flanges are each 0.8 in thick.
Given:
Desired rod stress σrod 30 ksi Nrods 10 L 30 ft S sallow 20 ksi
Number of rods Rod length Clevis strength
d 0.75 in
Rod diameter
Young's modulus Clevis flange thickness
6
E 30 10 psi t 0.8 in
S ballow 40 ksi Assumptions: The rods share the load equally, and there is one clevis for all ten rods. Solution:
See Figures 4-12 and 4-13 in the text, Figure 4-19, and Mathcad file P0419. A
π d
2
2
A 0.442 in
1.
Calculate the cross-sectional area of one rod.
2.
Determine the force required to achieve the desired stress level in one rod. F σrod = F σrod A F 13.254 kip A
3.
Determine the total force required to achieve the desired stress level in all rods. Ftotal Nrods F
4
Ftotal 132.5 kip
This force is transmitted through the clevis pin, which is in double shear. 4.
Calculate the minimum required clevis pin diameter for the allowable shear stress. Divide the load by 2 because of the double shear loading.
τpin =
Ftotal 2 Apin
Solving for the pin diameter
=
2 Ftotal
π d
2
= S sallow
d
2 Ftotal
π S sallow
d 2.054 in
Round this up to the next higher decimal equivalent of a common fraction ( 2 1/8) 5.
d 2.125 in
Check the bearing stress in the clevis due to the pin on one side of the clevis. Bearing stress area
Ab d t
Bearing force
Fb
Bearing stress
σb
Ftotal 2 Fb Ab
2
Ab 1.700 in
Fb 66.268 kip
σb 39.0 ksi
Since this is less than S ballow, this pin diameter is acceptable. © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 6.
4-19-2
Determine the tearout stress in the clevis. Shear area (see Figure 4-19)
2
Tearout length
2
Atear = 2 t R ( 0.5 d )
Shear force Ftear
Ftotal
Ftear 66.268 kip
2
Shear stress and strength R
d
τ=
Ftear Atear
=
Ftear 2
2 t R ( 0.5 d )
2
FIGURE 4-19
= S sallow
Tearout Diagram for Problem 4-19
2
Solving for the clevis radius, R
Ftear 2 R ( 0.5 d) 2 t S sallow
R 2.328 in
Round this up to the next higher decimal equivalent of a common fraction ( 2 3/8)
R 2.375 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-20-1
PROBLEM 4-20 Statement:
Repeat Problem 4-19 for 12 rods, each 1 cm in diameter and 10 m long. The desired rod stress is 20 MPa. The allowable normal stress in the clevis and pin is 280 MPa and their allowable shear stress is 140 MPa. Each clevis flange is 2 cm wide.
Units:
kN 10 newton
Given:
Desired rod stress σrod 200 MPa
3
6
9
MPa 10 Pa
GPa 10 Pa d 10 mm
Rod diameter
Number of rods
Nrods 12
Young's modulus
E 207 GPa
Rod length Clevis strength
L 10 m S sallow 140 MPa
Clevis flange thickness
t 20 mm
S ballow 280 MPa Assumptions: The rods share the load equally, and there is one clevis for all twelve rods. Solution:
See Figures 4-12 and 4-13 in the text, Figure 4-20, and Mathcad file P0420. A
π d
2
A 78.54 mm
1.
Calculate the cross-sectional area of one rod.
2.
Determine the force required to achieve the desired stress level in one rod.
σrod = 3.
F
F σrod A
A
4
2
F 15.708 kN
Determine the total force required to achieve the desired stress level in all rods. Ftotal Nrods F
Ftotal 188.5 kN
This force is transmitted through the clevis pin, which is in double shear. 4.
Calculate the minimum required clevis pin diameter for the allowable shear stress. Divide the load by 2 because of the double shear loading.
τpin =
Ftotal 2 Apin
Solving for the pin diameter
=
2 Ftotal
π d
2
= S sallow
2 Ftotal
d
π S sallow d 30 mm
Round this up to the next higher even mm 5.
d 29.277 mm
Check the bearing stress in the clevis due to the pin on one side of the clevis. Bearing stress area
Ab d t
Bearing force
Fb
Bearing stress
σb
Ftotal 2 Fb Ab
Ab 600 mm
2
Fb 94.248 kN
σb 157.1 MPa
Since this is less than S ballow, this pin diameter is acceptable. © 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0420.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed. 6.
4-20-2
Determine the tearout stress in the clevis. Shear area (see Figure 4-19)
2
Tearout length
2
Atear = 2 t R ( 0.5 d )
Shear force Ftear
Ftotal
Ftear 94.248 kN
2
Shear stress and strength R
d
τ=
Ftear Atear
=
Ftear 2
2 t R ( 0.5 d )
2
= S sallow
FIGURE 4-20 Tearout Diagram for Problem 4-20
2
Solving for the clevis radius, R
Ftear 2 R ( 0.5 d) 2 t S sallow
Round this up to the next higher even mm
R 22.544 mm
R 24 mm
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, P0420.xmcd mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-21-1
PROBLEM 4-21 Statement:
Figure P4-9 shows an automobile wheel with two common styles of lug wrench being used to tighten the wheel nuts, a single-ended wrench in (a), and a double-ended wrench in (b). In each case two hands are required to provide forces respectively at A and B as shown. The distance between points A and B is 1 ft in both cases and the handle diameter is 0.625 in. The wheel nuts require a torque of 70 ft-lb. Find the maximum principle stress and maximum deflection in each wrench design.
Given:
Distance between A and B
d AB 1 ft
Tightening torque Wrench diameter
T 70 ft lbf d 0.625 in
Assumptions: 1. The forces exerted by the user's hands lie in a plane through the wrench that is also parallel to the plane of the wheel. 2. The applied torque is perpendicular to the plane of the forces. 3. By virtue of 1 and 2 above, this is a planar problem that can be described in a 2D FBD. Solution:
See Figure 4-21 and Mathcad file P0421. 12" = dAB
1. In Problem 3-21 we found that for both cases
F
F 70 lbf 2. From examination of the FBDs, we see that, in both cases, the arms are in bending and the stub that holds the socket wrench is in pure torsion. The maximum bending stress in the arm will occur near the point where the arm transitions to the stub. The stress state at this transition is very complicated, but we can find the nominal bending stress there by treating the arm as a cantilever beam, fixed at the transition point. For both cases the torque in the stub is the same.
T F (a) Single-ended Wrench
12" = dAB F
6"
Case (a) T
2. The bending moment at the transition is F
Ma F d AB
(b) Double-ended Wrench
Ma 840 lbf in FIGURE 4-21
3. The tensile stress at this point is found from
Moment of inertia
4.
I
Free Body Diagrams for Problem 4-21
π d
4
64
Dist to extreme fibre
c 0.5 d
Stress
σx
M a c I
4
I 0.00749 in c 0.313 in
σx 35.05 ksi
There are no other stress components present at this point, so x is the maximum principle stress here and
σ1 σx
σ1 35.0 ksi
σ2 0 psi
σ3 0 psi
T 840 in lbf
5.
The torque in the stub is
6.
The shear stress at any point on the outside surface of the stub is found from
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
7.
Polar moment of inertia
J 2 I
Shear stress
τxy
4
J 0.0150 in
Tc
τxy 17.52 ksi
J
There are no other stress components present along the outside surface of the stub, so
σ1 τxy 8.
4-21-2
σ1 17.5 ksi
σ2 0 psi
σ3 σ1
Thus, the maximum principle stress for case (a) is on the upper surface of the handle (arm) near the point where it transitions to the stub. There will be two deflection components that we can calculate separately and then add (superposition). One will come from the bending of the arm and one will come from the twisting of the stub, projected out to the end of the arm.
9.
Deflection of the arm due to bending only for a stub length of stub 3 in: 6
E 30 10 psi
Assuming that the wrenches are made from steel
6
G 11.7 10 psi
3
F d AB
From Figure B-1(a), Appendix B,
yarm
yarm 0.179 in
From equation (4.24), the angular twist of the stub is
θstub
The deflection at the end of the arm due to the stub twist is
ystub d AB θstub
ystub 0.173 in
So, the total deflection is
ya yarm ystub
ya 0.352 in
3 E I T stub
θstub 0.014 rad
J G
Case (b) Mb
10. The bending moment at the transition is
F d AB 2
Mb 420 lbf in
11. The tensile stress at this point is found from
σx
Stress
M b c I
σx 17.52 ksi
12. There are no other stress components present at this point, so x is the maximum principle stress here and
σ1 σx 13. The torque in the stub is 14.
σ1 17.5 ksi
σ2 0 psi
σ3 0 psi
T 840 in lbf
The shear stress at any point on the outside surface of the stub is found from Shear stress
τxy
Tc J
τxy 17.52 ksi
15. There are no other stress components present along the outside surface of the stub, so
σ1 τxy
σ1 17.5 ksi
σ2 0 psi
σ3 σ1
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-21-3
16. Thus, the maximum principle stress for case (b) is the same on the upper surface of the handle (arm) near the point where it transitions to the stub, and on the outside surface of the stub. There will be two deflection components that we can calculate separately and then add (superposition). One will come from the bending of the arm and one will come from the twisting of the stub, projected out to the end of the arm. F 0.5 d AB
Deflection of the arm due to bending only: From Figure B-1(a), Appendix B,
yarm
From equation (4.24), the angular twist of the stub is
θstub
The deflection at the end of the arm due to the stub twist is
ystub
So, the total deflection is
yb yarm ystub
3 E I T stub J G d AB 2
θstub
3
yarm 0.022 in
θstub 0.014 rad
ystub 0.086 in
yb 0.109 in
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-22-1
PROBLEM 4-22 Statement:
A roller-blade skate is shown in Figure P4-10. The polyurethane wheels are 72 mm dia. The skate-boot-foot combination weighs 2 kg. The effective "spring rate" of the person-skate subsystem is 6000 N/m. The axles are 10-mm-dia steel pins in double shear. Find the stress in the pins for a 100-kg person landing a 0.5-m jump on one foot. (a) Assume all 4 wheels land simultaneously. (b) Assume that one wheel absorbs all the landing force.
Given:
Axle pin diameter
Solution:
See Figure P4-10 and Mathcad file P0422.
d 10 mm
Fa 897 N
Fb 3.59 kN
1.
From Problem 3-22, we have the forces for cases (a) and (b):
2.
In both cases, this is the force on one axle. The shear force will be one half of these forces because the pins are in double shear. Shear area
As
π d
2
As 78.54 mm
4
2
Shear stress Case (a) all wheels landing
τa
Case (b) one wheel landing
τb
Fa 2 As Fb 2 As
τa 5.71 MPa
τb 22.9 MPa
© 2011 Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ. All rights reserved. This publication is protected by Copyright and written permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or likewise. For information regarding permission(s), write to: Rights and Permissions Department, Pearson Education, Inc., Upper Saddle River, NJ 07458.
MACHINE DESIGN - An Integrated Approach, 4th Ed.
4-23a-1
PROBLEM 4-23a Statement:
A beam is supported and loaded as shown in Figure P4-11a. Find the reactions, maximum shear, maximum moment, maximum slope, maximum bending stress, and maximum deflection for the data given in row a from Table P4-2.
Given:
Beam length
L 1 m
Distance to distributed load
a 0.4 m
L b
Distance to concentrated load b 0.6 m w 200 N m
Concentrated load
F 500 N 8
I 2.85 10
Moment of inertia
a
1
Distributed load magnitude
Distance to extreme fiber c 2.00 10
4
m
F
w
R2
R1
2
m
FIGURE 4-23A Free Body Diagram for Problem 4-23
Solution: 1.
2.
See Figures 4-23 and Mathcad file P0423a.
The reactions, maximum shear and maximum moment were all found in Problem 3-23a. Those results are summarized here. Load function
q(x) = R1-1 - w0 + w